RMXS-DVM SM
RMXS-DVM SM
RMXS-DVM SM
[Applied Models]
Super Multi Plus : Cooling only
Super Multi Plus : Heat Pump
D-Series
Si18-525B
Table of Contents i
SUPER MULTI PLUS
D-Series
Cooling Only
Indoor Unit
<R-410A>
FTKS25DVM FTKS20DVMA FDKS25CVMB FFQ25B7V1B
FTKS35DVM FTKS25DVMA FDKS35CVMB FFQ35B7V1B
FTKS50BVMB FTKS35DVMA CDKS50CVMB FFQ50B7V1B
FTKS60BVMB FTKS50BVMA8 CDKS60CVMB FFQ60B7V1B
FTKS71BVMB FTKS60BVMA8 CDKS25CVMA FCQ35BVE
FTK50AZVMB FTKS71BVMA8 CDKS35CVMA FCQ50BVE
FTK60AZVMB CDKS50CVMA FCQ60BVE
FTK71AZVMB CDKS60CVMA FCQ71BVE
FBQ60BV1
FBQ71BV1
FHQ35BUV1B9
FHQ50BUV1B9
FHQ60BUV1B9
<R-22>
FTKD25DVM FTK50AVM CDKD25CVM CDKD25EAVM
FTKD35DVM FTK60AVM CDKD35CVM CDKD35EAVM
FTKD50FVM FTK71AVM CDKD50CVM
FTKD60FVM CDKD60CVM
FTKD71FVM
Outdoor Unit
<R-410A>
RMKS112DVM RMKS112DV1A BPMKS967A2 BPMKS967A2B
RMKS140DVM RMKS140DV1A BPMKS967A3 BPMKS967A3B
RMKS160DVM RMKS160DV1A
<R-22>
RMKD112DVM BPMKD967A2
RMKD140DVM BPMKD967A3
RMKD160DVM
Si18-525B
ii Table of Contents
Heat Pump
Indoor Unit
<R-410A>
FTXS20DVMA CDXS25CVMA FLXS25BVMA FFQ25B7V1B
FTXS25DVMA CDXS35CVMA FLXS35BVMA FFQ35B7V1B
FTXS35DVMA CDXS50CVMA FLXS50BVMA FFQ50B7V1B
FTXS50BVMA8 CDXS60CVMA FLXS60BVMA FFQ60B7V1B
FTXS60BVMA8 CDXS25DVMT FVXS35BVMA FCQ35BVE
FTXS71BVMA8 CDXS35DVMT FVXS50BVMA FCQ50BVE
FTXS20DVMT CDXS50DVMT FCQ60BVE
FTXS25DVMT CDXS60DVMT FCQ71BVE
FTXS35DVMT FBQ60BV1
FTXS50DVMT FBQ71BV1
FTXS60DVMT FBQ60BVL
FTXS71DVMT FBQ71BVL
FHQ35BUV1B9
FHQ50BUV1B9
FHQ60BUV1B9
Outdoor Unit
<R-410A>
RMXS112DVM RMXS112DV1A RMXS112DVLT BPMKS967A2
RMXS140DVM RMXS140DV1A RMXS140DVLT BPMKS967A3
RMXS160DVM RMXS160DV1A RMXS160DVLT
Si18-525B
Table of Contents iii
1. Introduction .......................................................................................... viii
1.1 Safety Cautions..................................................................................... viii
1.2 Used Icons ............................................................................................. xii
Part 1 List of Functions ................................................................ 1
1. List of Functions......................................................................................2
1.1 Cooling Only.............................................................................................2
1.2 Heat Pump .............................................................................................13
Part 2 Specifications .................................................................. 21
1. Specifications........................................................................................22
1.1 Cooling Only...........................................................................................22
1.2 Heat Pump .............................................................................................42
Part 3 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram ........... 59
1. Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram..................................60
1.1 Outdoor Unit ...........................................................................................60
1.2 Branch Provider Unit ..............................................................................66
1.3 Wall Mounted Type ................................................................................67
1.4 Duct Connected Type.............................................................................76
1.5 Floor / Ceiling Suspended Dual Type.....................................................78
1.6 Floor Standing Type...............................................................................81
1.7 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (600600)............................................84
1.8 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (950950)............................................87
1.9 Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type ................................................................90
1.10 Ceiling Suspended Type ........................................................................92
Part 4 Refrigerant Circuit ........................................................... 95
1. Refrigerant Circuit .................................................................................96
1.1 Outdoor Units .........................................................................................96
1.2 BP Units .................................................................................................98
2. Functional Parts Layout ........................................................................99
2.1 Outdoor Units .........................................................................................99
3. Refrigerant Flow for Each Operation Mode.........................................100
3.1 Cooling Operation ................................................................................100
3.2 Heating Operation ................................................................................101
3.3 Cooling Oil Return Operation ...............................................................102
3.4 Heating Oil Return Operation & Defrost Operation ..............................103
Part 5 Function.......................................................................... 105
1. Operation Mode ..................................................................................107
2. Basic Control .......................................................................................108
2.1 Normal Operation.................................................................................108
2.2 Compressor PI Control .........................................................................109
2.3 Electronic Expansion Valve PI Control .................................................112
2.4 Cooling Operation Fan Control.............................................................113
Si18-525B
iv Table of Contents
3. Special Control ....................................................................................114
3.1 Startup Control .....................................................................................114
3.2 Oil Return Operation ............................................................................115
3.3 Defrosting Operation ............................................................................117
3.4 Pump-down Residual Operation ..........................................................118
3.5 Restart Standby....................................................................................118
3.6 Stopping Operation ..............................................................................119
3.7 Pressure Equalization Prior to Startup .................................................119
4. Protection Control ...............................................................................120
4.1 High Pressure Protection Control .........................................................120
4.2 Low Pressure Protection Control..........................................................122
4.3 Discharge Pipe Protection Control .......................................................123
4.4 Inverter Protection Control ...................................................................124
4.5 Freeze-up Protection Control ...............................................................125
4.6 Dew Condensation Prevention Control ................................................126
5. Other Control.......................................................................................127
5.1 Demand Operation...............................................................................127
5.2 Heating Operation Prohibition ..............................................................127
6. BP Unit Control ...................................................................................128
6.1 BP Unit Command Conversion ............................................................128
6.2 BP Unit Electronic Expansion Valve Control ........................................129
6.3 SH Control in Cooling Operation..........................................................131
6.4 SC Control in Heating Operation..........................................................132
6.5 Heat Exchanger Isothermal Control in Heating Operation ...................132
7. Indoor Unit (RA Models)......................................................................133
7.1 Power-Airflow Dual Flaps, Wide Angle Louvers and Auto-Swing ........133
7.2 Fan Speed Control for Indoor Units......................................................134
7.3 Programme Dry Function .....................................................................135
7.4 Automatic Operation.............................................................................136
7.5 Thermostat Control...............................................................................137
7.6 Night Set Mode.....................................................................................138
7.7 ECONO Mode ......................................................................................139
7.8 MOLD PROOF Operation ....................................................................139
7.9 INTELLIGENT EYE..............................................................................140
7.10 HOME LEAVE Operation .....................................................................142
7.11 Inverter POWERFUL Operation...........................................................143
7.12 Other Functions....................................................................................144
8. Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) ................................................................146
8.1 Function Outline ...................................................................................146
8.2 Electric Function Parts .........................................................................147
8.3 Function Details....................................................................................148
Part 6 Test Operation ............................................................... 159
1. Test Operation ....................................................................................160
1.1 Procedure and Outline .........................................................................160
2. Outdoor Unit PCB Layout....................................................................165
3. Field Setting ........................................................................................166
3.1 Field Setting from Outdoor Unit............................................................166
3.2 Detail of Setting Mode..........................................................................172
Si18-525B
Table of Contents v
4. Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit .....................................................182
4.1 Explanation...........................................................................................182
4.2 Field Setting .........................................................................................183
4.3 Initial Setting Contents .........................................................................184
4.4 Local Setting Mode Number.................................................................185
4.5 Detailed Explanation of Setting Modes ................................................186
4.6 Centralized Group No. Setting .............................................................190
4.7 Maintenance Mode Setting...................................................................191
5. Test Operation and Field Setting for RA Indoor Unit...........................192
5.1 Test Operation from the Remote Controller .........................................192
5.2 Jumper Settings ...................................................................................193
Part 7 System Configuration..................................................... 195
1. System Configuration..........................................................................196
1.1 Operation Instructions ..........................................................................196
2. Instruction............................................................................................197
2.1 Outdoor Units .......................................................................................197
2.2 Wall Mounted, Duct, Floor/Ceiling, Floor Standing,
Wall Built-in Type .................................................................................198
2.3 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type ...........................................................278
2.4 Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type ..............................................................289
2.5 Ceiling Suspended Type ......................................................................299
Part 8 Troubleshooting ............................................................. 311
1. Caution for Diagnosis.........................................................................313
1.1 Troubleshooting with Operation Lamp .................................................313
1.2 Troubleshooting with the LED on the SkyAir Indoor Unit .....................314
1.3 Troubleshooting with the LED on the Outdoor Unit..............................315
1.4 Troubleshooting with the LED on the BP Unit ......................................316
2. Service Check Function ......................................................................317
2.1 RA Indoor Unit Wireless Remote Controller.........................................317
2.2 SkyAir Indoor Unit INSPECTION/TEST Button....................................320
2.3 SkyAir Indoor Unit Wired Remote Controller........................................321
2.4 SkyAir Indoor Unit Wireless Remote Controller ...................................322
2.5 Sky Air Indoor Unit Error Codes and LED Indication............................324
2.6 Malfunction Code Indication by Outdoor Unit PCB ..............................325
3. List of Malfunction Code......................................................................327
4. Troubleshooting for RA Indoor Unit.....................................................329
4.1 Indoor Unit PCB Abnormality ...............................................................329
4.2 Freeze-up Protection Control or High Pressure Control.......................330
4.3 Fan Motor or Related Abnormality .......................................................332
4.4 Thermistor or Related Abnormality (Indoor Unit)..................................335
4.5 Shutter Drive Motor / Shutter Limit Switch Abnormality .......................336
4.6 Check ...................................................................................................337
5. Troubleshooting for SkyAir Indoor Unit ...............................................340
5.1 Indoor Unit PCB Abnormality ...............................................................340
5.2 Malfunction of Drain Water Level System (Float Type)........................341
5.3 Malfunction of Drain System................................................................343
5.4 Indoor Unit Fan Motor Lock..................................................................344
5.5 Malfunction of Indoor Unit Fan Motor ...................................................345
Si18-525B
vi Table of Contents
5.6 Swing Flap Motor Malfunction / Lock ...................................................347
5.7 Malfunction of Capacity Setting............................................................349
5.8 Malfunction of Heat Exchanger Thermistor (R2T)................................350
5.9 Malfunction of Heat Exchanger Thermistor (R3T)................................351
5.10 Malfunction of Suction Air Thermistor ..................................................352
5.11 Malfunction of Remote Controller Thermistor.......................................353
5.12 Transmission Error (between Indoor Unit and Remote Controller) ......354
5.13 Transmission Error (between Main and Sub Remote Controller).........355
5.14 Malfunction of Field Setting Switch ......................................................356
5.15 Check ...................................................................................................357
6. Troubleshooting for BP Unit ................................................................359
6.1 Malfunction of Electronic Expansion Valve ..........................................359
6.2 Faulty BP Unit PCB..............................................................................360
6.3 Faulty BP Liquid or Gas Pipe Thermistor .............................................361
6.4 Transmission Error between Indoor Unit and BP Unit..........................362
6.5 Transmission Error between Outdoor Unit and BP Unit.......................364
6.6 Check ...................................................................................................365
7. Troubleshooting for Outdoor Unit........................................................366
7.1 Faulty Outdoor Unit PCB......................................................................366
7.2 Actuation of High Pressure Switch.......................................................367
7.3 Actuation of Low Pressure Switch........................................................368
7.4 Compressor Motor Lock.......................................................................369
7.5 Malfunction of Outdoor Unit Fan Motor ................................................370
7.6 Malfunction of Moving Part of Electronic Expansion Valve ..................371
7.7 Abnormal Discharge Pipe Temperature...............................................372
7.8 Malfunction of Thermistor for Outdoor Air (R1T) ..................................373
7.9 Malfunction of Discharge Pipe Thermistor (R3T) .................................374
7.10 Malfunction of Thermistor (R2T) for Suction Pipe ................................375
7.11 Malfunction of Thermistor (R4T) for Outdoor Unit Heat Exchanger .....376
7.12 Malfunction of Receiver Gas Pipe Thermistor (R5T)............................377
7.13 Outdoor Unit: Malfunction of High Pressure Sensor ............................378
7.14 Malfunction of Low Pressure Sensor....................................................379
7.15 Malfunction of Inverter Radiating Fin Temperature Rise......................380
7.16 Inverter Compressor Abnormal ............................................................381
7.17 Inverter Current Abnormal ....................................................................382
7.18 Inverter Start up Error...........................................................................383
7.19 Malfunction of Transmission between Inverter and Control PCB.........384
7.20 Malfunction of Inverter Radiating Fin Temperature Rise Sensor .........386
7.21 Faulty Combination of Inverter and Fan Driver ....................................387
7.22 Low Pressure Drop Due to Refrigerant Shortage or
Electronic Expansion Valve Failure......................................................388
7.23 Power Supply Insufficient or Instantaneous Failure .............................389
7.24 Check Operation not Executed ............................................................391
7.25 Malfunction in other Indoor Unit or other BP Unit.................................392
7.26 Mismatching of Indoor Unit, BP Unit and Outdoor Unit ........................393
7.27 Refrigerant System not Set, Incompatible Wiring/Piping......................394
7.28 Malfunction of System, Refrigerant System Address Undefined..........395
8. Check..................................................................................................396
9. Thermistor Resistance / Temperature Characteristics........................398
10.Pressure Sensor .................................................................................400
Si18-525B
Table of Contents vii
Part 9 Removal Procedure........................................................ 401
1. Outdoor Unit........................................................................................402
1.1 Removal of Outer Panels .....................................................................402
1.2 Removal of PCB...................................................................................409
1.3 Removal of Solenoid Valve, Four Way Valve and Motorized Valve.....420
1.4 Removal of Thermistor Assembly ........................................................421
1.5 Removal of Fan Motor..........................................................................422
2. BP Unit ................................................................................................425
2.1 Removal of PCB...................................................................................425
2.2 Removal of Solenoid Valve Coil ...........................................................428
Part 10Appendix......................................................................... 431
1. Piping Diagrams..................................................................................432
1.1 Outdoor Units .......................................................................................432
1.2 BP Units ...............................................................................................433
1.3 Indoor Units..........................................................................................434
2. Wiring Diagrams..................................................................................442
2.1 Outdoor Units .......................................................................................442
2.2 BP Units ...............................................................................................445
2.3 Indoor Units..........................................................................................447
Index ............................................................................................. i
Drawings & Flow Charts .............................................................. vii
Introduction Si18-525B
viii
1. Introduction
1.1 Safety Cautions
Cautions and
Warnings
Be sure to read the following safety cautions before conducting repair work.
The caution items are classified into Warning and Caution. The Warning
items are especially important since they can lead to death or serious injury if they are not
followed closely. The Caution items can also lead to serious accidents under some
conditions if they are not followed. Therefore, be sure to observe all the safety caution items
described below.
About the pictograms
This symbol indicates the item for which caution must be exercised.
The pictogram shows the item to which attention must be paid.
This symbol indicates the prohibited action.
The prohibited item or action is shown in the illustration or near the symbol.
This symbol indicates the action that must be taken, or the instruction.
The instruction is shown in the illustration or near the symbol.
After the repair work is complete, be sure to conduct a test operation to ensure that the
equipment operates normally, and explain the cautions for operating the product to the
customer.
1.1.1 Cautions Regarding Safety of Workers
Warning
Be sure to disconnect the power cable plug from the plug socket before
disassembling the equipment for repair.
Working on the equipment that is connected to the power supply may cause an
electrical shook.
If it is necessary to supply power to the equipment to conduct the repair or
inspecting the circuits, do not touch any electrically charged sections of the
equipment.
If the refrigerant gas is discharged during the repair work, do not touch the
discharged refrigerant gas.
The refrigerant gas may cause frostbite.
When disconnecting the suction or discharge pipe of the compressor at the
welded section, evacuate the refrigerant gas completely at a well-ventilated
place first.
If there is a gas remaining inside the compressor, the refrigerant gas or
refrigerating machine oil discharges when the pipe is disconnected, and it may
cause injury.
If the refrigerant gas leaks during the repair work, ventilate the area. The
refrigerant gas may generate toxic gases when it contacts flames.
The step-up capacitor supplies high-voltage electricity to the electrical
components of the outdoor unit.
Be sure to discharge the capacitor completely before conducting repair work.
A charged capacitor may cause an electrical shock.
Do not start or stop the air conditioner operation by plugging or unplugging the
power cable plug.
Plugging or unplugging the power cable plug to operate the equipment may
cause an electrical shock or fire.
Si18-525B Introduction
ix
Be sure to wear a safety helmet, gloves, and a safety belt when working at a
high place (more than 2m). Insufficient safety measures may cause a fall
accident.
In case of R410A refrigerant models, be sure to use pipes, flare nuts and tools
for the exclusive use of the R410A refrigerant.
The use of materials for R22 refrigerant models may cause a serious accident
such as a damage of refrigerant cycle as well as an equipment failure.
Warning
Caution
Do not repair the electrical components with wet hands.
Working on the equipment with wet hands may cause an electrical shock.
Do not clean the air conditioner by splashing water.
Washing the unit with water may cause an electrical shock.
Be sure to provide the grounding when repairing the equipment in a humid or
wet place, to avoid electrical shocks.
Be sure to turn off the power switch and unplug the power cable when cleaning
the equipment.
The internal fan rotates at a high speed, and cause injury.
Be sure to conduct repair work with appropriate tools.
The use of inappropriate tools may cause injury.
Be sure to check that the refrigerating cycle section has cooled down enough
before conducting repair work.
Working on the unit when the refrigerating cycle section is hot may cause
burns.
Use the welder in a well-ventilated place.
Using the welder in an enclosed room may cause oxygen deficiency.
Introduction Si18-525B
x
1.1.2 Cautions Regarding Safety of Users
Warning
Be sure to use parts listed in the service parts list of the applicable model and
appropriate tools to conduct repair work. Never attempt to modify the
equipment.
The use of inappropriate parts or tools may cause an electrical shock,
excessive heat generation or fire.
If the power cable and lead wires have scratches or deteriorated, be sure to
replace them.
Damaged cable and wires may cause an electrical shock, excessive heat
generation or fire.
Do not use a joined power cable or extension cable, or share the same power
outlet with other electrical appliances, since it may cause an electrical shock,
excessive heat generation or fire.
Be sure to use an exclusive power circuit for the equipment, and follow the local
technical standards related to the electrical equipment, the internal wiring
regulations, and the instruction manual for installation when conducting
electrical work.
Insufficient power circuit capacity and improper electrical work may cause an
electrical shock or fire.
Be sure to use the specified cable for wiring between the indoor and outdoor
units. Make the connections securely and route the cable properly so that there
is no force pulling the cable at the connection terminals.
Improper connections may cause excessive heat generation or fire.
When wiring between the indoor and outdoor units, make sure that the terminal
cover does not lift off or dismount because of the cable.
If the cover is not mounted properly, the terminal connection section may cause
an electrical shock, excessive heat generation or fire.
Do not damage or modify the power cable.
Damaged or modified power cable may cause an electrical shock or fire.
Placing heavy items on the power cable, and heating or pulling the power cable
may damage the cable.
Do not mix air or gas other than the specified refrigerant (R410A / R22) in the
refrigerant system.
If air enters the refrigerating system, an excessively high pressure results,
causing equipment damage and injury.
If the refrigerant gas leaks, be sure to locate the leaking point and repair it
before charging the refrigerant. After charging refrigerant, make sure that there
is no refrigerant leak.
If the leaking point cannot be located and the repair work must be stopped, be
sure to perform pump-down and close the service valve, to prevent the
refrigerant gas from leaking into the room. The refrigerant gas itself is
harmless, but it may generate toxic gases when it contacts flames, such as fan
and other heaters, stoves and ranges.
When relocating the equipment, make sure that the new installation site has
sufficient strength to withstand the weight of the equipment.
If the installation site does not have sufficient strength and if the installation
work is not conducted securely, the equipment may fall and cause injury.
Si18-525B Introduction
xi
Check to make sure that the power cable plug is not dirty or loose, then insert
the plug into a power outlet securely.
If the plug has dust or loose connection, it may cause an electrical shock or fire.
Be sure to install the product correctly by using the provided standard
installation frame.
Incorrect use of the installation frame and improper installation may cause the
equipment to fall, resulting in injury.
For unitary type
only
Be sure to install the product securely in the installation frame mounted on the
window frame.
If the unit is not securely mounted, it may fall and cause injury.
For unitary type
only
When replacing the coin battery in the remote controller, be sure to disposed
of the old battery to prevent children from swallowing it.
If a child swallows the coin battery, see a doctor immediately.
Warning
Caution
Installation of a leakage breaker is necessary in some cases depending on the
conditions of the installation site, to prevent electrical shocks.
Do not install the equipment in a place where there is a possibility of
combustible gas leaks.
If the combustible gas leaks and remains around the unit, it may cause a fire.
Check to see if the parts and wires are mounted and connected properly, and
if the connections at the soldered or crimped terminals are secure.
Improper installation and connections may cause excessive heat generation,
fire or an electrical shock.
If the installation platform or frame has corroded, replace it.
Corroded installation platform or frame may cause the unit to fall, resulting in
injury.
Check the grounding, and repair it if the equipment is not properly grounded.
Improper grounding may cause an electrical shock.
Introduction Si18-525B
xii
1.2 Used Icons
Icons are used to attract the attention of the reader to specific information. The meaning of each
icon is described in the table below:
Be sure to measure the insulation resistance after the repair, and make sure
that the resistance is 1 M or higher.
Faulty insulation may cause an electrical shock.
Be sure to check the drainage of the indoor unit after the repair.
Faulty drainage may cause the water to enter the room and wet the furniture
and floor.
Do not tilt the unit when removing it.
The water inside the unit may spill and wet the furniture and floor.
Be sure to install the packing and seal on the installation frame properly.
If the packing and seal are not installed properly, water may enter the room and
wet the furniture and floor.
For unitary type
only
Caution
Icon Type of
Information
Description
Note:
Note A note provides information that is not indispensable, but may
nevertheless be valuable to the reader, such as tips and tricks.
Caution
Caution A caution is used when there is danger that the reader, through
incorrect manipulation, may damage equipment, loose data, get
an unexpected result or has to restart (part of) a procedure.
Warning
Warning A warning is used when there is danger of personal injury.
Reference A reference guides the reader to other places in this binder or
in this manual, where he/she will find additional information on a
specific topic.
Si18-525B
List of Functions 1
Part 1
List of Functions
1. List of Functions......................................................................................2
1.1 Cooling Only.............................................................................................2
1.2 Heat Pump .............................................................................................13
List of Functions Si18-525B
2 List of Functions
1. List of Functions
1.1 Cooling Only
1.1.1 R-410A Models
Category Functions
R
M
K
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Category Functions
R
M
K
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
5
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
Remote
Controller
Wireless
Inverter Powerful Operation Wired
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 3
Category Functions
R
M
K
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
1
A
Category Functions
R
M
K
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
1
A
Basic Function Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health & Clean Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
5
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
Remote
Controller
Wireless
Inverter Powerful Operation Wired
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
4 List of Functions
Category Functions
F
T
K
S
2
5
3
5
D
V
M
F
T
K
S
5
0
-
7
1
B
V
M
B
Category Functions
F
T
K
S
2
5
3
5
D
V
M
F
T
K
S
5
0
-
7
1
B
V
M
B
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
PAM Control
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
O
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor
Swing Compressor
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
O
Rotary Compressor
Reluctance DC Motor Longlife Filter (Option)
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Mold Proof Air Filter O O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps O O Wipe-clean Flat Panel O O
Power-Airflow Diffuser Washable Grille
Wide-Angle Louvers O O Filter Cleaning Indicator
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O O Mold Proof Operation O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O Heating Dry Operation
3-D Airflow O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Comfort Airflow Mode Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) 72-Hour On/Off Timer
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O Night Set Mode O O
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Wiring Error Check
Intelligent Eye O O
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Quick Warming Function
Hot-Start Function
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O
Automatic Defrosting Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O
Operation Automatic Operation High Ceiling Application
Programme Dry Function O O Chargeless
Fan Only O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left) O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation (Non-Inverter) Power Selection
Inverter Powerful Operation O O Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller (Option) O O
Priority-Room Setting
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O
ECONO Mode O
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O DIII-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Temperature Display Wired
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 5
Category Functions
F
T
K
5
0
-
7
1
A
Z
V
M
B
Category Functions
F
T
K
5
0
-
7
1
A
Z
V
M
B
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter O
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter O
PAM Control
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
Rotary Compressor
Reluctance DC Motor Longlife Filter (Option)
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap O Mold Proof Air Filter O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Power-Airflow Diffuser O Washable Grille O
Wide-Angle Louvers O Filter Cleaning Indicator
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O Mold Proof Operation
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O Heating Dry Operation
3-D Airflow O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Comfort Airflow Mode Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) 72-Hour On/Off Timer
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O Night Set Mode O
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Wiring-Error Check
Intelligent Eye
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
3
5
C
V
M
B
C
D
K
S
5
0
6
0
C
V
M
B
Category Functions
F
D
K
S
2
5
3
5
C
V
M
B
C
D
K
S
5
0
6
0
C
V
M
B
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
PAM Control
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor
Swing Compressor
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Rotary Compressor
Reluctance DC Motor Longlife Filter (Option)
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Mold Proof Air Filter O O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Power-Airflow Diffuser Washable Grille
Wide-Angle Louvers Filter Cleaning Indicator
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) Mold Proof Operation
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) Heating Dry Operation
3-D Airflow Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Comfort Airflow Mode Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) 72-Hour On/Off Timer
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O Night Set Mode O O
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Wiring-Error Check
Intelligent Eye
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Quick Warming Function
Hot-Start Function
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O
Automatic Defrosting Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O
Operation Automatic Operation High Ceiling Application
Programme Dry Function O O Chargeless
Fan Only O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left)
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Power-Selection
Inverter Powerful Operation O O Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller (Option) O O
Priority-Room Setting
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O
Home Leave Operation O O Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O
ECONO Mode Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O Wired
Signal Reception Indicator O O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
8 List of Functions
Category Functions
C
D
K
S
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
A
F
F
Q
2
5
-
6
0
B
7
V
1
B
Category Functions
C
D
K
S
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
A
F
F
Q
2
5
-
6
0
B
7
V
1
B
Basic Function Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O Health & Clean Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (Option) O
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille O
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Filter Cleaning Indicator O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Mold Proof Operation
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O
Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O
72-Hour On/Off Timer O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) Night Set Mode O
3-D Airflow Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Wiring-Error Check
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic) Flexible Voltage Correspondence O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) High Ceiling Application
Intelligent Eye Chargeless
Quick Warming Function Either Side Drain (Right or Left)
Hot-Start Function Power-Selection
Automatic Defrosting
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O
Programme Dry Function O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O
Fan Only O O Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O Wired O
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O
Signal Reception Indicator O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 9
Category Functions
F
C
Q
3
5
-
7
1
B
V
E
F
B
Q
6
0
7
1
B
V
1
F
H
Q
3
5
-
6
0
B
U
V
1
B
9
Category Functions
F
C
Q
3
5
-
7
1
B
V
E
F
B
Q
6
0
7
1
B
V
1
F
H
Q
3
5
-
6
0
B
U
V
1
B
9
Basic Function Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O O Health & Clean Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (Option) O O O
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille O O
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap
Filter Cleaning Indicator O O O
Mold Proof Operation
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Heating Dry Operation
Power-Airflow Diffuser Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O O
72-Hour On/Off Timer O O O
Night Set Mode
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
3-D Airflow Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Wiring-Error Check
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only)
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O O
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation Flexible Voltage Correspondence
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic) High Ceiling Application O O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Chargeless
Intelligent Eye Either Side Drain (Right or Left)
Quick Warming Function Power-Selection
Hot-Start Function
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
Automatic Defrosting
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
Programme Dry Function O O O Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O O
Fan Only O O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Wired O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
10 List of Functions
1.1.2 R-22 Models
Category Functions
R
M
K
D
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Category Functions
R
M
K
D
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
21
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
Remote
Controller
Wireless
Inverter Powerful Operation Wired
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 11
Category Functions
F
T
K
D
2
5
3
5
D
V
M
F
T
K
D
5
0
-
7
1
F
V
M
Category Functions
F
T
K
D
2
5
3
5
D
V
M
F
T
K
D
5
0
-
7
1
F
V
M
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter O
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter O
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
O
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (Option)
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel O O
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Filter Cleaning Indicator
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps O O Mold Proof Operation O
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers O O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O O Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O 72-Hour On/Off Timer
3-D Airflow O Night Set Mode O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O Wiring-Error Check
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O
Intelligent Eye O O High Ceiling Application
Quick Warming Function Chargeless
Hot-Start Function Either Side Drain (Right or Left) O O
Automatic Defrosting Power-Selection
Operation
Automatic Operation
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O O
Programme Dry Function O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O
Fan Only O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O
ECONO Mode O
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
12 List of Functions
Category Functions
F
T
K
5
0
-
7
1
A
V
M
C
D
K
D
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
C
D
K
D
2
5
/
3
5
E
A
V
M
Category Functions
F
T
K
5
0
-
7
1
A
V
M
C
D
K
D
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
C
D
K
D
2
5
/
3
5
E
A
V
M
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter O
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter O
PAM Control
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
Compressor
Oval Scroll Compressor
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Swing Compressor Longlife Filter (Option)
Rotary Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O
Reluctance DC Motor Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap O Washable Grille O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Filter Cleaning Indicator
Power-Airflow Diffuser O Mold Proof Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers O Heating Dry Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O O
3-D Airflow O 72-Hour On/Off Timer
Comfort Airflow Mode Night Set Mode O O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O O Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O O
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O O Wiring Error Check
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual)
Intelligent Eye Flexibility
Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O
Quick Warming Function
Hot-Start Function Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O O
Automatic Defrosting High Ceiling Application
Operation Automatic Operation Chargeless
Programme Dry Function O O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left) O
Fan Only O O O Power Selection
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation (Non-
Inverter)
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O O
Priority-Room Setting
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O O
Home Leave Operation O O O
ECONO Mode DIII-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O O
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O O Wired
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 13
1.2 Heat Pump
1.2.1 R-410A Models
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
M
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
5
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
15
~
15.5
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Fan Only
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option)
Inverter Powerful Operation Remote
Controller
Wireless
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock O
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
14 List of Functions
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
1
A
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
1
A
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
5
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
15
~
15.5
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Fan Only
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option)
Inverter Powerful Operation Remote
Controller
Wireless
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock O
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 15
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
L
T
Category Functions
R
M
X
S
1
1
2
1
4
0
1
6
0
D
V
L
T
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB)
5
~
46
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
15
~
15.5
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Fan Only
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option)
Inverter Powerful Operation Remote
Controller
Wireless
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock O
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
16 List of Functions
Category Functions
F
T
X
S
2
0
-
3
5
D
V
M
A
F
T
X
S
5
0
-
7
1
B
V
M
A
8
F
T
X
S
2
0
-
3
5
D
V
M
T
Category Functions
F
T
X
S
2
0
-
3
5
D
V
M
A
F
T
X
S
5
0
-
7
1
B
V
M
A
8
F
T
X
S
2
0
-
3
5
D
V
M
T
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
O
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
O O
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (Option)
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel O O O
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Filter Cleaning Indicator
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps O O O Mold Proof Operation O O
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers O O O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O O O Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O 72-Hour On/Off Timer
3-D Airflow O Night Set Mode O O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O O Wiring-Error Check
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O O
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O O
Intelligent Eye O O O High Ceiling Application
Quick Warming Function Chargeless
Hot-Start Function O O O Either Side Drain (Right or left) O O O
Automatic Defrosting Power-Selection
Operation
Automatic Operation O O O
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O O O
Programme Dry Function O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O O
Fan Only O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O O
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O
ECONO Mode O O
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 17
Category Functions
F
T
X
S
5
0
-
7
1
D
V
M
T
C
D
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
A
C
D
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
D
V
M
T
Category Functions
F
T
X
S
5
0
-
7
1
D
V
M
T
C
D
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
C
V
M
A
C
D
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
D
V
M
T
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
O
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel O
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Filter Cleaning Indicator
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps O Mold Proof Operation
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer O O O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) O 72-Hour On/Off Timer
3-D Airflow O Night Set Mode O O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O O Wiring-Error Check
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O O
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Flexible Voltage Correspondence O O O
Intelligent Eye O High Ceiling Application
Quick Warming Function Chargeless
Hot-Start Function O O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left) O
Automatic Defrosting Power-Selection
Operation
Automatic Operation O O O
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O O O
Programme Dry Function O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
O O O
Fan Only O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor) (Option) O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O O
Priority-Room Setting Wired
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O O O
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
18 List of Functions
Category Functions
F
L
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
B
V
M
A
F
V
X
S
3
5
5
0
B
V
M
A
F
F
Q
2
5
-
6
0
B
7
V
1
B
Category Functions
F
L
X
S
2
5
-
6
0
B
V
M
A
F
V
X
S
3
5
5
0
B
V
M
A
8
F
F
Q
2
5
-
6
0
B
7
V
1
B
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power
Control)
O O O
Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter O O
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter O O
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with
Photocatalytic Deodorizing
Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (Option) O
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille O O
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap O O Filter Cleaning Indicator O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Mold Proof Operation
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers O Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and
Down)
O O O
Timer
24-Hour On/Off Timer O O
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and
Left)
72-Hour On/Off Timer O
3-D Airflow Night Set Mode O O
Comfort Airflow Mode Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) O
Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED)
Display
O O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed O O Wiring-Error Check
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation O O
Anticorrosion Treatment of
Outdoor Heat Exchanger
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation
(Manual)
Flexible Voltage Correspondence
O O
Intelligent Eye High Ceiling Application
Quick Warming Function Chargeless
Hot-Start Function O O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left) O
Automatic Defrosting Power-Selection
Operation
Automatic Operation O O O
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
O O
Programme Dry Function O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact)
(Option)
O O
Fan Only O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
O O
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor)
(Option)
O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation O O Remote
Controller
Wireless O O O
Priority-Room Setting Wired O
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation O O
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch O O
Signal Reception Indicator O O
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
Si18-525B List of Functions
List of Functions 19
Category Functions
F
C
Q
3
5
-
7
1
B
V
E
F
B
Q
6
0
7
1
B
V
1
(
L
)
F
H
Q
3
5
-
6
0
B
U
V
1
B
9
Category Functions
F
C
Q
3
5
-
7
1
B
V
E
F
B
Q
6
0
7
1
B
V
1
(
L
)
F
H
Q
3
5
-
6
0
B
U
V
1
B
9
Basic
Function
Inverter (with Inverter Power Control) O O O Health &
Clean
Air Purifying Filter
Operation Limit for Cooling (CDB) Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
Operation Limit for Heating (CWB)
Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic
Deodorizing Function
PAM Control
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Compressor Oval Scroll Compressor Longlife Filter (option) O O O
Swing Compressor Mold Proof Air Filter O O O
Rotary Compressor Wipe-clean Flat Panel
Reluctance DC Motor Washable Grille O O
Comfortable
Airflow
Power-Airflow Flap Filter Cleaning Indicator O O O
Power-Airflow Dual Flaps Mold Proof Operation
Power-Airflow Diffuser Heating Dry Operation
Wide-Angle Louvers Good-Sleep Cooling Operation
Vertical Auto-Swing (Up and Down) O O Timer 24-Hour On/Off Timer
Horizontal Auto-Swing (Right and Left) 72-Hour On/Off Timer O O O
3-D Airflow Night Set Mode
Comfort Airflow Mode Worry Free
Reliability &
Durability
Auto-Restart (after Power Failure) O O O
3-Step Airflow (H/P Only) Self-Diagnosis (Digital, LED) Display O O O
Comfort
Control
Auto Fan Speed Wiring-Error Check
Indoor Unit Quiet Operation
Anticorrosion Treatment of Outdoor
Heat Exchanger
Night Quiet Mode (Automatic)
Flexibility Multi-Split / Split Type Compatible
Indoor Unit
O O O
Outdoor Unit Quiet Operation (Manual) Flexible Voltage Correspondence
Intelligent Eye High Ceiling Application O O O
Quick Warming Function Chargeless
Hot-Start Function O O O Either Side Drain (Right or Left)
Automatic Defrosting Power-Selection
Operation
Automatic Operation O O O
Remote
Control
5-Rooms Centralized Controller
(Option)
Programme Dry Function O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open-Pulse Contact) (Option)
Fan Only O O O
Remote Control Adaptor
(Normal Open Contact) (Option)
Lifestyle
Convenience
New Powerful Operation
(Non-Inverter)
Dlll-NET Compatible (Adaptor)
(Option)
O O O
Inverter Powerful Operation Remote
Controller
Wireless O O
Priority-Room Setting Wired O O O
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock
Home Leave Operation
ECONO Mode
Indoor Unit On/Off Switch
Signal Reception Indicator
Temperature Display
Another Room Operation
Note: O : Holding Functions
: No Functions
List of Functions Si18-525B
20 List of Functions
Si18-525B
Specifications 21
Part 2
Specifications
1. Specifications........................................................................................22
1.1 Cooling Only...........................................................................................22
1.2 Heat Pump .............................................................................................42
Specifications Si18-525B
22 Specifications
1. Specifications
1.1 Cooling Only
1.1.1 Outdoor Units
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.054 +Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.022
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMKS112DVM RMKS140DVM RMKS160DVM
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FCVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant Oil
Model DAPHNE FVC68D
Charge L 1.6
Refrigerant
Type R-410A
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate (H) m/min (cfm) 104 (3671) 106 (3742) 106 (3742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power
Consumption
W 88+88
Starting Current A 15.3-14.5-14.3 21.1-20.1-19.8 24.2-23.9-23.6
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation Sound dBA 52 53 54
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping Length
Total main piping
and branch
piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch
piping
m 60 80 90
Max. length for
each room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 23
50Hz 220-230-240V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.054 +Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.022
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMKS112DV1A RMKS140DV1A RMKS160DV1A
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FCVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant Oil
Model DAPHNE FVC68D
Charge L 1.6
Refrigerant
Type R-410A
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate (H) m/min (cfm) 104 (3671) 106 (3742) 106 (3742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power
Consumption
W 88+88
Starting Current A 15.3-14.5-14.3 21.1-20.1-19.8 24.2-23.9-23.6
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation Sound dBA 52 53 54
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping Length
Total main piping
and branch
piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch
piping
m 60 80 90
Max. length for
each room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Specifications Si18-525B
24 Specifications
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.050 +Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.025
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMKD112DVM RMKD140DVM RMKD160DVM
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FBVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant Oil
Model DAPHNE SE56P
Charge L 1.5
Refrigerant
Type R-22
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate (H) m/min (cfm) 104 (3671) 106 (3742) 106 (3742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power
Consumption
W 88+88
Starting Current A 15.3-14.5 19.7-18.7 24.2-23.9
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation Sound dBA 52 53 54
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping Length
Total main piping
and branch
piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch
piping
m 60 80 90
Max. length for
each room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 25
1.1.2 BP Unit
50Hz 220-240V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. BP or Indoor Unit Max. Height - BP or Indoor Unit Min. Height Max. 15m.
Set up BP and indoor unit within 15m height difference.
2. The piping connection must be cut so as to suit the piping sizes of the indoor unit which will be connected.
The same sizes should be used for the piping on the outdoor unit.
3. ( )* : including auxiliary piping length
Model BPMKS967A2 BPMKS967A3
Connectable Indoor Units 1~2 Units 1~3 Units
Casing Color Paintingless
Power Consumption W 10 10
Running Current A 0.05 0.05
Refrigerant Type R-410A
Dimension (HWD) mm 180294(650)*350
Package Dimension (HWD) mm 257738427
Machine Weight kg 7.5 8
Gross Weight kg 11 12
Number of Wiring Connections 4 for Interunit Wiring
Piping
Connection
(Brazing)
Liquid mm Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.42 Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.43
Gas mm Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.92 Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.93
Drain mm Drain Processingless
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Max. Piping Length m
Amount of Additional Charge g/m
Max. Height Difference m
Max. Combination kW 14.2 20.8
Min. Combination kW 2.5 2.5
Accessories
Installation Manual pc. 1
L Shape Reducer pc.
For Main
Liquid 1 (For I.D. 6.4)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 12.7)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 15.9, 19.1)
For Branch
Liquid 2 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5) 3 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 9.5)
Hanger Metal pc. 4
Screws pc. 8 (M48)
Heat Insulation (2pc. is 1 set) 3 Set 4 Set
Binding Band pc. 2
Drawing No. 4D050057B
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
26 Specifications
50Hz 230V
Note:
1. BP or Indoor Unit Max. Height - BP or Indoor Unit Min. Height Max. 15m.
Set up BP and indoor unit within 15m height difference.
2. The piping connection must be cut so as to suit the piping sizes of the indoor unit which will be connected.
The same sizes should be used for the piping on the outdoor unit.
3. ( )* : including auxiliary piping length
Model BPMKS967A2B BPMKS967A3B
Connectable Indoor Units 1~2 Units 1~3 Units
Casing Color Paintingless
Power Consumption W 10 10
Running Current A 0.05 0.05
Refrigerant Type R-410A
Dimension (HWD) mm 180294(650)*350
Package Dimension (HWD) mm 257738427
Machine Weight kg 7.5 8
Gross Weight kg 11 12
Number of Wiring Connections 4 for Interunit Wiring
Piping
Connection
(Brazing)
Liquid mm Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.42 Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.43
Gas mm Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.92 Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.93
Drain mm Drain Processingless
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Max. Piping Length m
Amount of Additional Charge g/m
Max. Height Difference m
Max. Combination kW 14.2 20.8
Min. Combination kW 2.0 2.0
Accessories
Installation Manual pc. 1
L Shape Reducer pc.
For Main
Liquid 1 (For I.D. 6.4)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 12.7)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 15.9, 19.1)
For Branch
Liquid 2 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5) 3 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 9.5)
Hanger Metal pc. 4
Screws pc. 8 (M48)
Heat Insulation (2pc. is 1 set) 3 Set 4 Set
Binding Band pc. 2
Drawing No. 4D050058B
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 27
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. BP or Indoor Unit Max. Height - BP or Indoor Unit Min. Height Max. 15m.
Set up BP and indoor unit within 15m height difference.
2. The piping connection must be cut so as to suit the piping sizes of the indoor unit which will be connected.
The same sizes should be used for the piping on the outdoor unit.
3. ( )* : including auxiliary piping length
Model BPMKD967A2 BPMKD967A3
Connectable Indoor Units 1~2 Units 1~3 Units
Casing Color Paintingless
Power Consumption W 10 10
Running Current A 0.05 0.05
Refrigerant Type R22
Dimension (HWD) mm 180294(650)*350
Package Dimension (HWD) mm 257738427
Machine Weight kg 7.5 8
Gross Weight kg 11 12
Number of Wiring Connections
3 for Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 for Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP, BP-BP)
4 for Interunit Wiring (BP-Indoor Unit)
Piping
Connection
(Brazing)
Liquid mm Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.42 Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.43
Gas mm Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.92 Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.93
Drain mm Drain Processingless
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Max. Piping Length m
Amount of Additional Charge g/m
Max. Height Difference m
Max. Combination kW 14.2 20.8
Min. Combination kW 2.5 2.5
Accessories
Installation Manual pc. 1
L Shape Reducer pc.
For Main
Liquid 1 (O.D. 9.5 to I.D. 6.4)
Gas 1 (O.D. 15.9 to I.D. 12.7)
Gas 1 (O.D. 19.1 to I.D. 15.9, 19.1)
For Branch
Gas 2 (O.D. 15.9 to I.D. 12.7, 9.5) 3 (O.D. 15.9 to I.D. 12.7, 9.5)
Liquid 1 (O.D. 6.4 to I.D. 9.5)
Hanger Metal pc. 4
Screws pc. 8 (M48)
Heat Insulation (2pc. is 1 set) 3 Set 4 Set
Binding Band pc. 2
Drawing No. 4D050451A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
28 Specifications
1.1.3 Indoor Units
Wall Mounted Type
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
50Hz 230V
Model FTKS25DVM FTKS35DVM
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.7 (307) 8.9 (314)
M 6.7 (237) 6.9 (242)
L 4.7 (166) 4.8 (169)
SL 3.9 (138) 4.0 (141)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17-0.16 / 0.17-0.16 0.19-0.18 / 0.19-0.18
Power Consumption (Rated) W 35-35 / 35-35 40-40 / 40-40
Power Factor % 93.6-95.1 / 93.6-95.1 95.7-96.6 / 95.7-96.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 265855340
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 37/25/22 39/26/23
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049321 3D049322
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTKS50BVMB FTKS60BVMB
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 11.4 (402) 16.2 (572)
M 9.7 (342) 13.6 (480)
L 8.0 (282) 11.4 (402)
SL 7.1 (251) 10.2 (360)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.18 0.18
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40 40
Power Factor % 96.6 96.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 290795238 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 280840338 3371,147366
Weight kg 9 12
Gross Weight kg 13 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 44/40/35/32 45/41/36/33
Sound Power H dBA 63 63
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D040781A 3D040782A
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 29
50Hz 230V
Model FTKS71BVMB FTK50AZVMB
Rated Capacity 7.1kW Class 5.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 16.7 (590) 12.3 (434)
M 14.2 (501) 10.7 (378)
L 11.6 (409) 9.1 (321)
SL 10.6 (374) 8.0 (282)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43 54
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removal-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.20 0.18
Power Consumption (Rated) W 45 40
Power Factor % 96.4 96.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238 2981,050190
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366 2891,183367
Weight kg 12 12
Gross Weight kg 17 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 46/42/37/34 44/40/35/32
Sound Power H dBA 63 60
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 15.9 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D040783A 3D034991
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTK60AZVMB FTK71AZVMB
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color Almond White Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 13.0 (459) 13.7 (484)
M 11.5 (406) 11.8 (417)
L 9.9 (349) 9.9 (349)
SL 8.8 (311) 8.8 (311)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 54 54
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removal-Washable-Mildew Proof Removal-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.20 0.22
Power Consumption (Rated) W 45 50
Power Factor % 97.8 98.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2981,050190 2981,050190
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2891,183367 2891,183367
Weight kg 12 12
Gross Weight kg 17 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 45/41/37/34 46/42/37/34
Sound Power H dBA 61 62
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 15.9
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D034992 3D034993
Specifications Si18-525B
30 Specifications
50Hz 220-230-240V
Model FTKS20DVMA FTKS25DVMA
Rated Capacity 2.0kW Class 2.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.7 (307) 8.7 (307)
M 6.7 (237) 6.7 (237)
L 4.7 (166) 4.7 (166)
SL 3.9 (138) 3.9 (138)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17-0.16-0.15 0.17-0.16-0.15
Power Consumption (Rated) W 35-35-35 35-35-35
Power Factor % 93.6-95.1-97.2 93.6-95.1-97.2
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 265855340
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 37/25/22 37/25/22
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049754 3D049288
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTKS35DVMA
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.9 (314)
M 6.9 (244)
L 4.8 (169)
SL 4.0 (141)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.19-0.18-0.17
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40-40-40
Power Factor % 95.7-96.6-98.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 238800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340
Weight kg 9
Gross Weight kg 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 38/26/23
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4
Gas mm 9.5
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049289
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 31
50Hz 240V
Model FTKS50BVMA8 FTKS60BVMA8
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 11.4 (402) 16.2 (573)
M 9.8 (346) 13.9 (490)
L 8.7 (306) 11.9 (420)
SL 7.7 (271) 10.7 (378)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17 0.19
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40 45
Power Factor % 98 98.7
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 290795238 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 280840338 3371,147366
Weight kg 9 12
Gross Weight kg 13 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 44/40/35/32 45/41/36/33
Sound Power H dBA 63 63
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D047569 3D047570
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTKS71BVMA8
Rated Capacity 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 16.8 (593)
M 14.2 (501)
L 11.9 (420)
SL 11.2 (394)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.21
Power Consumption (Rated) W 50
Power Factor % 99.2
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366
Weight kg 12
Gross Weight kg 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 46/42/37/34
Sound Power H dBA 63
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4
Gas mm 15.9
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D047571
Specifications Si18-525B
32 Specifications
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Model FTKD25DVM FTKD35DVM
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.9 (314) 9.0 (318)
M 7.3 (256) 7.4 (259)
L 5.6 (198) 5.7 (201)
SL 4.8 (169) 4.9 (173)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 18 18
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17-0.16/0.19-0.18 0.19-0.18/0.21-0.20
Power Consumption (Rated) W 35-35/40-40 40-40/45-45
Power Factor % 93.6-95.1/95.7-96.6 96.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 265855340
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 37/28/25 39/29/26
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049308A 3D049309A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTKD50FVM FTKD60FVM
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 16.8 (593) 17.5 (618)
M 14.0 (494) 14.6 (516)
L 11.8 (417) 12.2 (431)
SL 10.4 (367) 10.8 (381)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.19-0.18-0.17/0.19-0.18 0.21-0.20-0.19/0.21-0.20
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40 45
Power Factor % 95.7-96.6-98.0/95.7-96.6 97.4-97.8-98.7/97.4-97.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366 3371,147366
Weight kg 12 12
Gross Weight kg 17 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 44/40/35/32 45/41/36/33
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 15.9
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D056204 3D056205
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 33
50Hz 220-230-240V / 60Hz 220-230V
Model FTKD71FVM
Rated Capacity 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 18.3 (646)
M 15.3 (540)
L 12.7 (448)
SL 11.3 (399)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.23-0.22-0.21/0.23-0.22
Power Consumption (Rated) W 50
Power Factor % 98.8-98.8-99.2/98.8-98.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366
Weight kg 12
Gross Weight kg 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 46/42/37/34
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 9.5
Gas mm 15.9
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D056206
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
34 Specifications
50Hz 230V
Model FTK50AVM
Rated Capacity 5.0kW class
Front Panel Color Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.9 (455)
M 11.4 (402)
L 9.9 (349)
SL 8.3 (293)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 54
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.18
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40
Power Factor % 96.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2981,050190
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2891,183367
Weight kg 12
Gross Weight kg 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 44/40/35/32
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4
Gas mm 12.7
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D036711
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FTK60AVM FTK71AVM
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color Almond White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 13.6 (480) 14.3 (505)
M 12.0 (424) 12.3 (434)
L 10.4 (367) 10.4 (367)
SL 9.3 (328) 9.3 (328)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 54 54
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.20 0.22
Power Consumption (Rated) W 45 50
Power Factor % 97.8 98.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2981,050190 2981,050190
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2891,183367 2891,183367
Weight kg 12 12
Gross Weight kg 17 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 45/41/37/34 46/42/37/34
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 9.5
Gas mm 15.9 15.9
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D036712 3D036713
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 35
Duct Connected Type
50Hz 230V
Note: The operating sound is based on the rear side suction inlet and the external static pressure 40 Pa.
Operating sound for under side suction inlet : [operating sound for rear side suction inlet] +5 dB.
However, when installation to which the external static pressure becomes low is carried out,
5 dB or more may go up.
Model FDKS25CVMB FDKS35CVMB
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.5 (335) 10.0 (353)
M 8.8 (311) 9.3 (328)
L 8.0 (282) 8.5 (300)
SL 6.7 (237) 7.0 (247)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47 0.47
Power Consumption (Rated) W 100 100
Power Factor % 92.5 92.5
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 200900620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,106751
Weight kg 25 25
Gross Weight kg 31 31
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D048947C 3D048948C
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model CDKS50CVMB CDKS60CVMB
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424) 16.0 (565)
M 11.0 (388) 14.8 (523)
L 10.0 (353) 13.5 (477)
SL 8.4 (297) 11.2 (395)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 130 130
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.64 0.74
Power Consumption (Rated) W 140 160
Power Factor % 95.1 94.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 2001,100620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,306751
Weight kg 27 30
Gross Weight kg 34 37
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/35/33/31 38/36/34/32
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D046067A 3D046068A
Specifications Si18-525B
36 Specifications
50Hz 230V
Model CDKS25CVMA CDKS35CVMA
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.5 (335) 10.0 (353)
M 8.8 (311) 9.3 (328)
L 8.0 (282) 8.5 (300)
SL 6.7 (237) 7.0 (247)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47 0.47
Power Consumption (Rated) W 100 100
Power Factor % 92.5 92.5
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 200900620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,106751
Weight kg 25 25
Gross Weight kg 31 31
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
Moisture Removal L/h 1.2 1.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D049723 3D049724
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model CDKS50CVMA CDKS60CVMA
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424) 16.0 (565)
M 11.0 (388) 14.8 (523)
L 10.0 (353) 13.5 (477)
SL 8.4 (297) 11.2 (395)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 130 130
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.64 0.74
Power Consumption (Rated) W 140 160
Power Factor % 95.1 94.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 2001,100620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,306751
Weight kg 27 30
Gross Weight kg 34 37
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/35/33/31 38/36/34/32
Moisture Removal L/h 2.9 3.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D049725 3D049726
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 37
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note: The operating sound is based on the rear side suction inlet and the external static pressure 40 Pa.
Operating sound for under side suction inlet : [operating sound for rear side suction inlet] +5 dB.
However, when installation to which the external static pressure becomes low is carried out,
5 dB or more may go up.
Model CDKD25CVM CDKD35CVM
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.5 (335) 10.0 (353)
M 8.8 (311) 9.3 (328)
L 8.0 (282) 8.5 (300)
SL 6.7 (237) 7.0 (247)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47-0.47/0.52-0.53 0.47-0.48/0.53-0.54
Power Consumption (Rated) W 97-100/108-113 97-100/110-113
Power Factor % 93.8-92.5/94.4-92.7 93.8-90.6/94.3-91.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 200900620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,106751
Weight kg 25 25
Gross Weight kg 31 31
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D046077A 3D046078A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model CDKD50CVM CDKD60CVM
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424) 16.0 (565)
M 11.0 (388) 14.8 (523)
L 10.0 (353) 13.5 (477)
SL 8.4 (297) 11.2 (395)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 130 130
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Running Current (Rated) A 0.65-0.66/0.79-0.80 0.74-0.75/0.89-0.90
Power Consumption (Rated) W 133-140/164-167 152-160/185-187
Power Factor % 93.0-92.2/94.4-90.8 93.4-92.8/94.5-90.3
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 2001,100620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,306751
Weight kg 27 30
Gross Weight kg 33 36
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/35/33/31 38/36/34/32
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 15.9
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D046079A 3D046080A
Specifications Si18-525B
38 Specifications
50Hz 220-230-240V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note: 1. The operating sound is based on the rear side suction inlet and the external static pressure 35 Pa.
Operating sound for under side suction inlet : [operating sound for rear side suction inlet] +6 dB.
However, when installation to which the external static pressure becomes low is carried out,
6 dB or more may go up.
Model CDKD25EAVM CDKD35EAVM
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.7 (307) 8.7 (307)
M 8.0 (282) 8.0 (282)
L 7.3 (258) 7.3 (258)
SL 6.2 (219) 6.2 (219)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47-0.48-0.49/0.52-0.53 0.47-0.48-0.49/0.52-0.53
Power Consumption (Rated) W 70-71-72/72-73 70-71-72/72-73
Power Factor % 67.7-64.3-61.2/62.9-59.9 67.7-64.3-61.2/62.9-59.9
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200700620 200700620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 274906751 274906751
Weight kg 21 21
Gross Weight kg 29 29
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
External Static Pressure Pa 35 35
Moisture Removal L/h 1.2 1.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D052111 3D052112
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 39
Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type
50Hz 230V
50Hz 230-240V
( ) : dimension including control box
Model FFQ25B7V1B FFQ35B7V1B
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 55700700 55700700
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.0 (318) 10.0 (353)
M
L 6.5 (230) 6.5 (230)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 55 55
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.37 0.40
Power Consumption (Rated) W 73 84
Power Factor % 85.8 91.3
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 260 (286)575575 260 (286)575575
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 370687674 370687674
Weight kg 17.5 17.5
Gross Weight kg 21 21
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 29.5/24.5 32.0/25.0
Sound Power H dBA 46.5 49.0
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D040444A 3D040442A
Model FFQ50B7V1B FFQ60B7V1B
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 55700700 55700700
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424)-13.0 (459) 15.0 (530)-15.5 (547)
M
L 8.0 (283) 10.0 (353)-11.0 (388)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 55 55
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.49-0.51 0.61-0.63
Power Consumption (Rated) W 97-117 120-140
Power Factor % 86.1-95.6 85.5-92.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 260 (286)575575 260 (286)575575
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 370687674 370687674
Weight kg 17.5 17.5
Gross Weight kg 21 21
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 36-38/27-28 41-42/32-34
Sound Power H dBA 53-55 58-59
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D040437, 3D040439 3D040431, 3D040434
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
40 Specifications
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220V
Model FCQ35BVE FCQ50BVE
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 40950950 40950950
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 14.0 (494) 15.0 (530)
M
L 10.0 (353) 11.0 (388.3)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 45 45
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.8 0.8
Power Consumption (Rated) W 140/161 140/161
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 230840840 230840840
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 305930920 305930920
Weight kg 24 24
Gross Weight kg 32 32
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 33/29 33/29
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare)
Gas mm 9.5 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049093A 3D049093A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model FCQ60BVE FCQ71BVE
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 40950950 40950950
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 19.0 (670.7) 19.0 (670.7)
M
L 14.0 (494.2) 14.0 (494.2)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 45 45
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.8 0.8
Power Consumption (Rated) W 161/181 161/181
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 230840840 230840840
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 305930920 305930920
Weight kg 24 24
Gross Weight kg 32 32
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 35/30 35/30
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 9.5 (Flare)
Gas mm 12.7 (Flare) 15.9 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049093A 3D049093A
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 41
Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type
50Hz 220-230-240V
Ceiling Suspended Type
Model FBQ60BV1 FBQ71BV1
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 551,100500 551,100500
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 17.0 (600) 19.0 (670)
M
L 13.0 (459) 14.0 (494)
SL
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 110 12.5
Speed Steps 2 steps 2 steps
Air Filter Resin Net (with mold resistant) Resin Net (with mold resistant)
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.9 1.1
Power Consumption (Rated) W 165 184
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 3001,000800 3001,000800
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 4001171991 4001171991
Weight kg 41 41
Gross Weight kg 50 50
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 41/35 41/35
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 9.5 (Flare)
Gas mm 12.7 (Flare) 15.9 (Flare)
Drain mm VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049097 3D049097
Model FHQ35BUV1B9 FHQ50BUV1B9 FHQ60BUV1B9
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White White
Dimensions (HWD)
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 13.0 (458) 13.0 (458) 17.0 (600)
M
L 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353) 13.0 (459)
SL
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62 62
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 195960680 195960680 1951,160680
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2791,046818 2791,046818 2791,246818
Weight kg 24 25 27
Gross Weight kg 31 32 35
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 37/32 38/33 39/33
Sound Power H/L dBA 53/48 54/49 55/49
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare)
Gas mm 9.5 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D037992E 3D037992E 3D037992E
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
42 Specifications
1.2 Heat Pump
1.2.1 Outdoor Units
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.054 + Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.022
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMXS112DVM RMXS140DVM RMXS160DVM
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Heating Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
12.5 (10,750) 16.0 (13,760) 17.5 (15,050)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FCVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant
Oil
Model DAPHNE FVC68D
Charge L 1.6
Refrigerant
Type R-410A
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate
(H)
Cooling
m/min
(cfm)
104 (3,671) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Heating
m/min
(cfm)
102 (3,600) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power Consumption W 88+88
Starting Current A 18.5-17.6-17.3 23.7-22.6-22.2 25.2-24.9-24.6
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation
Sound
Cooling dBA 52 53 54
Heating dBA 54 55 56
Piping
Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping
Length
Total main piping and
branch piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch piping m 60 80 90
Max. length for each
room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Heating Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Indoor ; 20CDB
Outdoor ; 7CDB / 6CWB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 43
50Hz 220-230-240V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.054 + Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.022
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMXS112DV1A RMXS140DV1A RMXS160DV1A
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Heating Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
12.5 (10,750) 16.0 (13,760) 17.5 (15,050)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FCVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant
Oil
Model DAPHNE FVC68D
Charge L 1.6
Refrigerant
Type R-410A
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate
(H)
Cooling
m/min
(cfm)
104 (3,671) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Heating
m/min
(cfm)
102 (3,600) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power Consumption W 88+88
Starting Current A 18.5-17.6-17.3 23.7-22.6-22.2 25.2-24.9-24.6
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation
Sound
Cooling dBA 52 53 54
Heating dBA 54 55 56
Piping
Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping
Length
Total main piping and
branch piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch piping m 60 80 90
Max. length for each
room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Heating Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Indoor ; 20CDB
Outdoor ; 7CDB / 6CWB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Specifications Si18-525B
44 Specifications
60Hz 220V
Note:
1. Refrigerant charge is required. (Chargeless piping length 0m)
Formula for calculation charge : R (kg)
R = Total length (m) of liquid pipe size at 9.50.054 + Total length (m) of liquid piping size at 6.40.022
2. The data are based on the conditions shown in the table below.
Model RMXS112DVLT RMXS140DVLT RMXS160DVLT
4HP 5HP 6HP
Cooling Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
11.2 (9,630) 14.0 (12,040) 15.5 (13,330)
Heating Capacity
kW
(kcal/h)
12.5 (10,750) 16.0 (13,760) 17.5 (15,050)
Total Indoor Unit Capacity kW 5.5~14.5 7.0~18.2 8.0~20.8
Power Consumption W
Running Current A
Casing Color Ivory White
Compressor
Type Hermetically Sealed Scroll Type
Model JT100FCVD
Motor Output
(2.2kW/60rps)
kW 2.5 3.0 3.5
Refrigerant
Oil
Model DAPHNE FVC68D
Charge L 1.6
Refrigerant
Type R-410A
Charge kg 5.1
Air Flow Rate
(H)
Cooling
m/min
(cfm)
104 (3,671) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Heating
m/min
(cfm)
102 (3,600) 106 (3,742) 106 (3,742)
Fan
Type Propeller
Motor Output W 70+70
Running Current A 0.4+0.4
Power Consumption W 88+88
Starting Current A 18.5-17.6-17.3 23.7-22.6-22.2 25.2-24.9-24.6
Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,345900320
Package Dimensions (HWD) mm 1,475925390
Weight kg 136
Gross Weight kg 146
Operation
Sound
Cooling dBA 52 53 54
Heating dBA 54 55 56
Piping
Connection
Liquid mm 9.5 (Flare Connection)
Gas mm 19.1 (Brazing Connection)
Drain mm 18
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
No. of Wiring Connection 3 For Power Supply (Including Earth Wiring), 2 For Interunit Wiring (Outdoor Unit-BP)
Max. Interunit
Piping
Length
Total main piping and
branch piping
m 115 135 145
Total main piping m 55
Total branch piping m 60 80 90
Max. length for each
room
m 15
Necessity of Additional Charge kg/m Necessary
Max. Installation Height Difference m 30 (Between Indoor or BP Unit and Outdoor Unit), 15 (Both between Indoor Units and BP Units)
Cooling Heating Piping Length
Indoor ; 27CDB / 19CWB
Outdoor ; 35CDB
Indoor ; 20CDB
Outdoor ; 7CDB / 6CWB
Main Piping : 5m
Branch Piping : 3m
Level difference:0m
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
BP Unit
Outdoor Unit
Main Piping
Branch Piping
Indoor Unit
(Q0143)
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 45
1.2.2 BP Units
50Hz 220-240V / 60Hz 220-230V
Note:
1. BP or Indoor Unit Max. Height - BP or Indoor Unit Min. Height Max. 15m.
Set up BP and indoor unit within 15m height difference.
2. The piping connection must be cut so as to suit the piping sizes of the indoor unit which will be connected.
The same sizes should be used for the piping on the outdoor unit.
3. ( )* : including auxiliary piping length
Model BPMKS967A2 BPMKS967A3
Connectable Indoor Units 1~2 Units 1~3 Units
Casing Color Paintingless
Power Consumption W 10 10
Running Current A 0.05 0.05
Refrigerant Type R-410A
Dimension (HWD) mm 180294(650)*350
Package Dimension (HWD) mm 257738427
Machine Weight kg 7.5 8
Gross Weight kg 11 12
Number of Wiring Connections 4 for Interunit Wiring
Piping
Connection
(Brazing)
Liquid mm Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.42 Main : 9.51 / Branch : 6.43
Gas mm Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.92 Main : 19.11 / Branch : 15.93
Drain mm Drain Processingless
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Max. Piping Length m
Amount of Additional Charge g/m
Max. Height Difference m
Max. Combination kW 14.2 20.8
Min. Combination kW 2.5 2.5
Accessories
Installation Manual pc. 1
L Shape Reducer pc.
For Main
Liquid 1 (For I.D. 6.4)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 12.7)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 15.9, 19.1)
For Branch
Liquid 2 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5) 3 (For I.D. 12.7, 9.5)
Gas 1 (For I.D. 9.5)
Hanger Metal pc. 4
Screws pc. 8 (M48)
Heat Insulation (2pc. is 1 set) 3 Set 4 Set
Binding Band pc. 2
Drawing No. 4D050057B
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
46 Specifications
1.2.3 Indoor Units
Wall Mounted Type
50Hz 220-230-240V
Model
FTXS20DVMA FTXS25DVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 2.0kW Class 2.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.7 (307) 9.4 (332) 8.7 (307) 9.4 (332)
M 6.7 (237) 7.6 (268) 6.7 (237) 7.6 (268)
L 4.7 (166) 5.8 (205) 4.7 (166) 5.8 (205)
SL 3.9 (138) 5.0 (177) 3.9 (138) 5.0 (177)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17-0.16-0.15 0.17-0.16-0.15 0.17-0.16-0.15 0.17-0.16-0.15
Power Consumption (Rated) W 35-35-35 35-35-35 35-35-35 35-35-35
Power Factor % 93.6-95.1-97.2 93.6-95.1-97.2 93.6-95.1-97.2 93.6-95.1-97.2
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 265855340
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 37/25/22 37/28/25 37/25/22 37/28/25
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049290 3D049291
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model
FTXS35DVMA
Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.9 (314) 9.7 (342)
M 6.9 (242) 7.9 (277)
L 4.8 (169) 6.0 (212)
SL 4.0 (141) 5.2 (184)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.19-0.18-0.17 0.19-0.18-0.17
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40-40-40 40-40-40
Power Factor % 95.7-96.6-98.0 95.7-96.6-98.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340
Weight kg 9
Gross Weight kg 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 38/26/23 38/29/26
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4
Gas mm 9.5
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049292
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 47
50Hz 240V
Model
FTXS50BVMA8 FTXS60BVMA8
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 11.4 (402) 12.6 (444) 16.2 (573) 17.4 (613)
M 9.8 (346) 10.9 (385) 13.9 (490) 15.3 (539)
L 8.7 (306) 9.3 (329) 11.9 (420) 13.1 (464)
SL 7.7 (271) 8.2 (291) 10.7 (378) 11.7 (412)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.17 0.17 0.19 0.19
Power Consumption (Rated) W 40 40 45 45
Power Factor % 98.0 98.0 98.7 98.7
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 290795238 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 280840338 3371,147366
Weight kg 9 12
Gross Weight kg 13 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 44/40/35/32 42/38/33/30 45/41/36/33 44/40/35/32
Sound Power H dBA 63 60 63 62
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D047566 3D047567
Model
FTXS71BVMA8
Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 16.8 (592) 18.7 (660)
M 14.2 (501) 16.1 (567)
L 11.9 (420) 13.6 (481)
SL 11.2 (394) 12.5 (441)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.21 0.21
Power Consumption (Rated) W 50 50
Power Factor % 99.2 99.2
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366
Weight kg 12
Gross Weight kg 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 46/42/37/34 46/42/37/34
Sound Power H dBA 63 63
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4
Gas mm 15.9
Drain mm 18.0
Drawing No. 3D047568
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
48 Specifications
60Hz 220V
Model
FTXS20DVMT FTXS25DVMT
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Capacity 2.0kW Class 2.5kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.7 (307) 9.4 (332) 8.7 (307) 9.4 (332)
M 6.7 (237) 7.6 (268) 6.7 (237) 7.6 (268)
L 4.7 (166) 5.8 (205) 4.7 (166) 5.8 (205)
SL 3.9 (138) 5.0 (177) 3.9 (138) 5.0 (177)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current A 0.17 0.17 0.17 0.17
Power Consumption W 35 35 35 35
Power Factor % 93.6 93.6 93.6 93.6
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 283800195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 265855340
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 12
Operation
Sound
H/L/SL dBA 38/25/22 38/28/25 38/25/22 38/28/25
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049891A 3D049892A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model
FTXS35DVMT FTXS50DVMT
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.9 (314) 9.7 (342) 11.4 (402) 12.6 (445)
M 6.9 (244) 7.9 (279) 9.7 (342) 10.8 (381)
L 4.8 (169) 6.0 (212) 8.0 (282) 8.9 (314)
SL 4.0 (141) 5.2 (184) 7.1 (251) 7.7 (272)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 40 40
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current A 0.19 0.19 0.19 0.19
Power Consumption W 40 40 40 40
Power Factor % 95.7 95.7 95.7 95.7
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 283800195 290795238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 265855340 280840338
Weight kg 9 9
Gross Weight kg 12 13
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 39//26/23 39//29/26 44/40/35/32 42/38/33/30
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049893A 3D049983
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 49
60Hz 220V
Model
FTXS60DVMT FTXS71DVMT
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Front Panel Color White White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 16.2 (572) 17.4 (614) 16.7 (590) 18.5 (653)
M 13.6 (480) 15.1 (533) 14.2 (501) 15.1 (533)
L 11.4 (402) 12.7 (448) 11.6 (409) 13.5 (477)
SL 10.2 (360) 11.4 (402) 10.6 (374) 12.1 (427)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 43 43
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current A 0.21 0.21 0.23 0.23
Power Consumption W 45 45 50 50
Power Factor % 97.4 97.4 98.8 98.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 2901,050238 2901,050238
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 3371,147366 3371,147366
Weight kg 12 12
Gross Weight kg 17 17
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 45/41/36/33 44/40/35/32 46/42/37/34 46/42/37/34
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 15.9
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D049984 3D049985
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
50 Specifications
Duct Connected Type
50Hz 230V
Model
CDXS25CVMA CDXS35CVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.5 (335) 9.5 (335) 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353)
M 8.8 (311) 8.8 (311) 9.3 (328) 9.3 (328)
L 8.0 (282) 8.0 (282) 8.5 (300) 8.5 (300)
SL 6.7 (237) 6.7 (237) 7.0 (247) 7.0 (247)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47 0.47 0.47 0.47
Power Consumption (Rated) W 100 100 100 100
Power Factor % 92.5 92.5 92.5 92.5
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 200900620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,106751
Weight kg 25 25
Gross Weight kg 31 31
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
Moisture Removal L/h 1.2 1.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D046469 3D046470
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model
CDXS50CVMA CDXS60CVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424) 12.0 (424) 16.0 (565) 16.0 (565)
M 11.0 (388) 11.0 (388) 14.8 (523) 14.8 (523)
L 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353) 13.5 (477) 13.5 (477)
SL 8.4 (297) 8.4 (297) 11.2 (395) 11.2 (395)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 130 130
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.64 0.64 0.74 0.74
Power Consumption (Rated) W 140 140 160 160
Power Factor % 95.1 95.1 94.0 94.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 2001,100620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,306751
Weight kg 27 30
Gross Weight kg 34 37
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/35/33/31 37/35/33/31 38/36/34/32 38/36/34/32
Moisture Removal L/h 2.9 3.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D046471 3D046472
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 51
60Hz 220V
Model
CDXS25DVMT CDXS35DVMT
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.5 (335) 10.0 (353)
M 8.8 (311) 9.3 (328)
L 8.0 (282) 8.5 (300)
SL 6.7 (237) 7.0 (247)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.47 0.47
Power Consumption (Rated) W 100 100
Power Factor % 92.5 92.5
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 200900620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,106751
Weight kg 25 25
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 35/33/31/29 35/33/31/29
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Moisture Removal l/h 1.2 1.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D049727 3D049728
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model
CDXS50DVMT CDXS60DVMT
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Front Panel Color
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424) 16.0 (565)
M 11.0 (388) 14.8 (523)
L 10.0 (353) 13.5 (477)
SL 8.4 (297) 11.2 (395)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 130 130
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.64 0.74
Power Consumption (Rated) W 140 160
Power Factor % 95.1 94.0
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 200900620 2001,100620
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2661,106751 2661,306751
Weight kg 27 30
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/35/33/31 38/36/34/32
External Static Pressure Pa 40 40
Moisture Removal l/h 2.9 3.9
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D049729 3D049730
Specifications Si18-525B
52 Specifications
Floor / Ceiling Suspended Dual Type
50Hz 230V
Model
FLXS25BVMA FLXS35BVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Front Panel Color Almond White Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 7.6 (268) 9.2 (325) 8.6 (304) 9.8 (346)
M 6.8 (240) 8.3 (293) 7.6 (268) 8.9 (314)
L 6.0 (212) 7.4 (261) 6.6 (233) 8.0 (282)
SL 5.2 (184) 6.6 (233) 5.6 (198) 7.2 (254)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 34 34
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.32 0.34 0.36 0.36
Power Consumption (Rated) W 70 74 78 78
Power Factor % 95.1 94.6 94.2 94.2
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 4901,050200 4901,050200
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2801,100566 2801,100566
Weight kg 16 16
Gross Weight kg 22 22
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 37/34/31/28 37/34/31/29 38/35/32/29 39/36/33/30
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D046600 3D046601
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Model
FLXS50BVMA FLXS60BVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 5.7kW Class
Front Panel Color Almond White Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 11.4 (402) 12.1 (427) 12.0 (424) 12.8 (452)
M 10.0 (353) 9.8 (346) 10.7 (378) 10.6 (374)
L 8.5 (300) 7.5 (265) 9.3 (328) 8.4 (297)
SL 7.5 (265) 6.8 (240) 8.3 (293) 7.5 (265)
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 34 34
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.45 0.45 0.47 0.45
Power Consumption (Rated) W 96 96 98 96
Power Factor % 92.8 92.8 90.7 92.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 4901,050200 4901,050200
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2801,100566 2801,100566
Weight kg 17 17
Gross Weight kg 24 24
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 47/43/39/36 46/41/35/33 48/45/41/39 47/42/37/34
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm 18.0 18.0
Drawing No. 3D046571 3D046572
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 53
Floor Standing Type
50Hz 230V
Model
FVXS35BVMA FVXS50BVMA
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class
Front Panel Color Almond White Almond White
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 8.3 (293) 9.2 (325) 10.8 (381) 13.2 (466)
M 6.3 (222) 7.1 (251) 9.2 (325) 11.3 (399)
L 4.3 (152) 5.0 (177) 7.7 (272) 9.4 (332)
SL 3.4 (120) 3.6 (127) 6.7 (237) 8.3 (293)
Fan
Type Cross Flow Fan Cross Flow Fan
Motor Output W 14+14 14+14
Speed Steps 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto 5 Steps, Quiet, Auto
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Upward Right, Left, Horizontal, Upward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.14 0.14 0.26 0.32
Power Consumption (Rated) W 32 32 55 70
Power Factor % 99.4 99.4 92.0 95.1
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 600650195 600650195
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 714770294 714770294
Weight kg 13 13
Gross Weight kg 19 19
Operation
Sound
H/M/L/SL dBA 39/33/27/24 39/33/26/23 44/40/36/33 45/40/36/33
Sound Power H dBA
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 12.7
Drain mm 20.0 20.0
Drawing No. 3D046650 3D046661
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
54 Specifications
Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type
50Hz 230V
50Hz 230-240V
( ) : dimension including control box
Model
FFQ25B7V1B FFQ35B7V1B
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 2.5kW Class 3.5kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 55700700 55700700
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 9.0 (318) 9.0 (318) 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353)
M
L 6.5 (230) 6.5 (230) 6.5 (230) 6.5 (230)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 55 55
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.37 0.32 0.40 0.36
Power Consumption (Rated) W 73 64 84 76
Power Factor % 85.8 87.0 91.3 91.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 260(286)575575 260(286)575575
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 370687674 370687674
Weight kg 17.5 17.5
Gross Weight kg 21 21
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 29.5/24.5 29.5/24.5 32.0/25.0 32.0/25.0
Sound Power H dBA 46.5 49.0
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 9.5 9.5
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D040445 3D040443
Model
FFQ50B7V1B FFQ60B7V1B
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 55700700 55700700
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 12.0 (424)-13.0 (459) 12.0 (424)-13.0 (459) 15.0 (530)-15.5 (547) 15.0 (530)-15.5 (547)
M
L 8.0 (283) 8.0 (283) 10.0 (353)-11.0 (388) 10.0 (353)-11.0 (388)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 55 55
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.49-0.51 0.45-0.46 0.61-0.63 0.56-0.57
Power Consumption (Rated) W 97-117 89-109 120-140 111-131
Power Factor % 86.1-95.6 86.0-98.7 85.5-92.6 86.2-95.8
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 260(286)575575 260(286)575575
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 370687674 370687674
Weight kg 17.5 17.5
Gross Weight kg 21 21
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 36-38/27-28 36-38/27-28 41-42/32-34 41-42/32-34
Sound Power H dBA 53-55 58-59
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 6.4
Gas mm 12.7 12.7
Drain mm VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20) VP20 (O.D 26 / I.D 20)
Drawing No. 3D040440, 3D040441 3D040435, 3D040436
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 55
50Hz 220-230V / 60Hz 220V
Model
FCQ35BVE FCQ50BVE
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 40950950 40950950
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 14.0 (494) 15.0 (530)
M
L 10.0 (353) 11.0 (388.3)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 45 45
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Rated) A 0.8 0.8
Power Consumption (Max. Rated) W 140/161 107/128 140/161 107/128
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 230840840 230840840
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 305930920 305930920
Weight kg 24 24
Gross Weight kg 32 32
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 33/29 33/29
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare)
Gas mm 9.5 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049093A 3D049093A
Model
FCQ60BVE FCQ71BVE
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 40950950 40950950
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 19.0 (670.7) 19.0 (670.7)
M
L 14.0 (494.2) 14.0 (494.2)
SL
Fan
Type Turbo Fan Turbo Fan
Motor Output W 45 45
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Horizontal, Downward Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.8 0.8
Power Consumption (Rated) W 161/181 128/148 161/181 128/148
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 230840840 230840840
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 305930920 305930920
Weight kg 24 24
Gross Weight kg 32 32
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 35/30 35/30
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 9.5 (Flare)
Gas mm 12.7 (Flare) 15.9 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP20 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049093A 3D049093A
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
56 Specifications
Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type
50Hz 220-230V
60Hz 220V
Model
FBQ60BV1 FBQ71BV1
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 551100500 551100500
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 17.0 (600) 19.0 (670)
M
L 13.0 (459) 14.0 (494)
SL
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 110 125
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Filter Resin Net (with mold resistant) Resin Net (with mold resistant)
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.9 1.1
Power Consumption (Rated) W 165 145 184 164
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 3001000800 3001000800
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 4001171991 4001171991
Weight kg 41 41
Gross Weight kg 50 50
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 41/35 41/35
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 9.5 (Flare)
Gas mm 12.7 (Flare) 15.9 (Flare)
Drain mm VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049097 3D049097
Model
FBQ60BVL FBQ71BVL
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 6.0kW Class 7.1kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White
Dimensions (HWD) 551100500 551100500
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 19.0 (670) 19.0 (670)
M
L 14.0 (494) 14.0 (494)
SL
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 125 125
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Filter Resin Net (with mold resistant) Resin Net (with mold resistant)
Running Current (Max. Rated) A 0.9 1.1
Power Consumption (Rated) W 165 145 184 164
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 3001000800 3001000800
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 4001171991 4001171991
Weight kg 41 41
Gross Weight kg 50 50
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 41/35 41/35
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 9.5 (Flare)
Gas mm 12.7 (Flare) 15.9 (Flare)
Drain mm VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25) VP25 (O.D. 32 / I.D. 25)
Drawing No. 3D049097 3D049097
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Si18-525B Specifications
Specifications 57
Ceiling Suspended Type
Model
FHQ35BUV1B9 FHQ50BUV1B9 FHQ60BUV1B9
Cooling Heating Cooling Heating Cooling Heating
Rated Capacity 3.5kW Class 5.0kW Class 6.0kW Class
Decoration
Panel
Color White White White
Dimensions (HWD)
Air Flow Rates
m/min
(cfm)
H 13.0 (458) 13.0 (458) 13.0 (458) 13.0 (458) 17.0 (600) 16.0 (565)
M
L 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353) 10.0 (353) 13.0 (459) 13.0 (459)
SL
Fan
Type Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan Sirocco Fan
Motor Output W 62 62 62
Speed Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps 2 Steps
Air Direction Control Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward Right, Left, Horizontal, Downward
Air Filter Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof Removable-Washable-Mildew Proof
Temperature Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control Microcomputer Control
Dimensions (HWD) mm 195960680 195960680 1951,160680
Packaged Dimensions (HWD) mm 2791,046818 2791,046818 2791,246818
Weight kg 24 25 27
Gross Weight kg 31 32 35
Operation
Sound
H/L dBA 37/32 38/33 39/33
Sound Power H/L dBA 53/48 54/49 55/49
Heat Insulation Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes Both Liquid and Gas Pipes
Piping Connection
Liquid mm 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare) 6.4 (Flare)
Gas mm 9.5 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare) 12.7 (Flare)
Drain mm VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20) VP20 (O.D. 26 / I.D. 20)
Drawing No. 3D037992E 3D037992E 3D037992E
Conversion Formulae
kcal/h=kW860
Btu/h=kW3414
cfm=m/min35.3
Specifications Si18-525B
58 Specifications
Si18-525B
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 59
Part 3
Printed Circuit Board
Connector Wiring Diagram
1. Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram..................................60
1.1 Outdoor Unit ...........................................................................................60
1.2 Branch Provider Unit ..............................................................................66
1.3 Wall Mounted Type ................................................................................67
1.4 Duct Connected Type.............................................................................76
1.5 Floor / Ceiling Suspended Dual Type.....................................................78
1.6 Floor Standing Type...............................................................................81
1.7 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (600600)............................................84
1.8 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (950950)............................................87
1.9 Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type ................................................................90
1.10 Ceiling Suspended Type ........................................................................92
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
60 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1. Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.1 Outdoor Unit
1.1.1 Control PCB (A1P)
Connectors 1) X1A Connector to Filter PCB (A3P)
2) X2A Connector for SVP (Hot Gas Bypass Valve)
3) X3A Connector for SVG (Receiver Gas Discharging Valve)
4) X5A Connector for 4 Way Valve
5) X6A Connector for Crankcase Heater
6) X25A Connector for Inverter PCB (A2P)
7) X26A Connector for Electronic Expansion Valve (Main)
8) X28A Connector for Electronic Expansion Valve (Sub Cool)
9) X34A Connector for Discharge Pipe Thermistor
10) X37A Connector for Thermistors
(Suction Pipe, Heat Exchanger and SC Heat Exchanger Gas Pipe)
11) X44A Connector for Outdoor Air Thermistor
12) X45A Connector for High Pressure Sensor
13) X46A Connector for Low Pressure Sensor
Note: Other Designation
1) HAP Service Monitor LED
2) H1P to H7P Service Monitor LED
3) BS1 to BS5 Push Button Switch (for Mode Select, Field Setting and Test Operation)
4) DS1 Dip Switch for Cool / Heat Selector
5) X1M Terminal for Cool / Heat Selector and Transmission to BP unit
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 61
PCB Detail
X25A
X28A
X26A
H1P
to H7P
BS1
to BS5
X1A X2A X3A
X5A
X6A
HAP
DS1
X1M
X46A X45A X44A X37A X34A
2P119093
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
62 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.1.2 Inverter PCB (A2P)
Connectors 1) X60A Connector for High Pressure Switch
2) X205A Connector for Control PCB (A1P)
3) X206A Connector for Fan Motor (Upper Side)
4) X207A Connector for Fan Motor (Lower Side)
5) LC, NC Terminal for Filter PCB (A3P)
RMX(K)S models
LC
NC
2P135876
X206A X207A X205A X60A
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 63
RMKD models
LC
NC
2P120962
X206A X207A X205A X60A
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
64 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.1.3 Filter PCB (A3P)
Connectors 1) X1A Connector for Control PCB (A1P)
2) LA, NA Terminal for X1M (Power Supply Terminal Strip)
3) LB, NB Terminal for Inverter PCB (A2P)
Note: Other Designation
1) F1U Fuse (250V 6.3A)
2) GND Earth Terminal
RMX(K)S models
NB
LB
GND
NA LA
X1A
F1U
2P135804
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 65
RMKD models
NB
LB
GND
NA LA
X1A
F1U
2P120963
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
66 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.2 Branch Provider Unit
Connectors
Note: Other Designations
X23A and X5M are not used for BPMKS967A2(B) and BPMKD967A2.
PCB Detail
1) X20A Connector for Bypass Electronic Expansion Valve
2) X21A to X23A Connector for Electronic Expansion Valve to Room A, B and C
3) X90A Connector for Thermistors
1) F2U Fuse (AC250V 3.15A)
2) X3M Terminal for Inter Connecting Wire to Room A
3) X4M Terminal for Inter Connecting Wire to Room B
4) X5M Terminal for Inter Connecting Wire to Room C
5) F1, F2 (on X6M) Terminal for Transmission to Outdoor Unit or Other BP units
6) L1, N1 (on X1M) Terminal for Power Supply
7) L2, N2 (on X1M) Terminal for Power Supply to other BP units
8) H1P(LED A) LED for Service Monitor
9) H2P~H5P (LED 1 to 4) LED for Fault Indication
X3M
X4M
X5M
F2U
3P152439
X22A
X21A
X20A
F2
X6M
X1M
F1
N2
L2
N1
L1
X90A X23A
H1P (LED A)
H2P (LED 1)
H3P (LED 2)
H4P (LED 3)
H5P (LED 4)
N
2
L
2
N
1
L
1
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 67
1.3 Wall Mounted Type
1.3.1 FTK(X)S 20~35 D
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
1) S1 Connector for DC fan motor
2) S6 Connector for swing motor (horizontal blades)
3) S21 Connector for centralized control (HA)
4) S26 Connector for display PCB
5) S28 Connector for signal receiver PCB
6) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
7) S35 Connector for INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB
1) S29 Connector for control PCB
1) S27 Connector for control PCB
1) S36 Connector for control PCB
1) V1 Varistor
2) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function (auto-restart)
Refer to page 193 for detail.
3) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
4) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON / OFF switch
2) LED1 LED for operation (green)
3) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
4) LED3 LED for INTELLIGENT EYE (green)
5) RTH1 (R1T) Room temperature thermistor
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
68 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB
PCB(4): INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB
V1
S1
FU1
S6
S26 S28 S32 JC JB JA LED A
S35
S21
(R4288)
PCB(2): Signal Receiver PCB PCB(3): Display PCB
S29
(R4289)
RTH1
SW1
S27
LED3 LED2 LED1
(R4290)
S36
(R4291)
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 69
1.3.2 FTKD 25/35 D
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
1) S1 Connector for AC fan motor
2) S6 Connector for swing motor (horizontal blades)
3) S7 Connector for AC fan motor (Hall IC)
4) S21 Connector for centralized control (HA)
5) S26 Connector for display PCB
6) S28 Connector for signal receiver PCB
7) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
8) S35 Connector for INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB
1) S29 Connector for control PCB
1) S27 Connector for control PCB
1) S36 Connector for control PCB
1) V1 Varistor
2) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function (auto-restart)
Refer to page 193 for detail.
3) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
4) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON / OFF switch
2) LED1 LED for operation (green)
3) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
4) LED3 LED for INTELLIGENT EYE (green)
5) RTH1 (R1T) Room temperature thermistor
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
70 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB
PCB(4): INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB
V1
FU1
S1
S6
S7
S26 S28 S32 JC JB JA LED A
S35
S21
(R4779)
PCB(2): Signal Receiver PCB PCB(3): Display PCB
S29
(R4289) RTH1
SW1
S27
LED3 LED2 LED1
(R4290)
S36
(R4547)
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 71
1.3.3 FTK(X)S 50~71 B, FTXS 50~71 D, FTKD 50~71 F
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(3) (Buzzer PCB)
PCB(4) (Display PCB)
PCB(5) (INTELLIGENT EYE sensor PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(3) (Buzzer PCB)
PCB(4) (Display PCB)
1) S1 Connector for DC fan motor
2) S6 Connector for swing motor (horizontal blades)
3) S8 Connector for swing motor (vertical blades)
4) S21 Connector for centralized control (HA)
5) S26 Connector for buzzer PCB
6) S28 Connector for signal receiver PCB
7) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
8) S35 Connector for Intelligent Eye sensor PCB
1) S29 Connector for control PCB
1) S27 Connector for control PCB
2) S38 Connector for display PCB
1) S37 Connector for buzzer PCB
1) S36 Connector for control PCB
1) V1 Varistor
2) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function
Refer to page 193 for detail.
3) LED A LED A for service monitor (green)
4) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON/OFF switch
1) RTH1 (R1T) Room temperature thermistor
4) LED1 LED for operation (green)
5) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
6) LED3 LED for HOME LEAVE operation (red)
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
72 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB (indoor unit)
PCB(2): Signal Receiver PCB PCB(3): Buzzer PCB
PCB(4): Display PCB PCB(5): Intelligent Eye sensor PCB
S1
V1
FU1
S6
S8
S26
(R2860)
S28 S32 JC JB JA LED A
S21
S35
SW1
S29
(R2861)
(R2862)
RTH1
S38
S27
LED1 LED2 LED3 S37
(R2863)
S36
(R2864)
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 73
1.3.4 FTK 50-71 A
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Power Supply PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (Signal Receiver PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Power Supply PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (Signal Receiver PCB)
1) S6 Connector for swing motor (horizontal swing)
2) S8 Connector for swing motor (vertical swing)
3) S21 Connector for centralized control
4) S24 Connector for display PCB
5) S26 Connector for signal receiver PCB
6) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
7) S37 Connector for power supply PCB
1) S36 Connector for control PCB
2) S201 Connector for fan motor
1) S25 Connector for control PCB
1) S31 Connector for room temperature thermistor
2) S27 Connector for control PCB
1) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat.
JC Power failure recovery function.
Refer to page 193 for detail.
2) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
1) V1 Varistor
2) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) LED1 LED for operation (green)
2) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
3) LED3 LED for HOME LEAVE operation (red)
1) SW1 (S1W) Operation switch
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
74 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB
PCB Detail PCB(2): Power Supply PCB
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 75
PCB Detail PCB(3):Display PCB
PCB Detail PCB (4): Signal Receiver PCB
SW1
PbF
PHOTO
2P084377- 1
SW1
I
RTH
WLU
3
C1
C2
C3
EX511 REV 12
S27
(R4977)
S31(RTH)
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
76 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.4 Duct Connected Type
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Display PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Display PCB)
PCB Detail PCB (1): Control PCB
1) S1 Connector for AC fan motor
2) S7 Connector for AC fan motor
3) S21 Connector for centralized control to 5 rooms
4) S26 Connector for display PCB
5) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
1) S1 Connector for control PCB
1) V1 Varistor
2) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function
Refer to page 193 for more detail.
3) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
4) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON/OFF switch
2) LED1 LED for operation (green)
3) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
4) LED3 LED for HOME LEAVE operation (red)
5) RTH1 (R1T) Room temperature thermistor
S1
V1
S7
S26
S32 JC JB JA
S21
2P131149 LED A
FU1
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 77
PCB Detail PCB (2): Display PCB
C1
C3
C2
W
L
U
P
b
F
2P084375
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
78 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.5 Floor / Ceiling Suspended Dual Type
Connectors PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Power Supply PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (Signal Receiver PCB)
Note: Other designations
PCB(1) (Control PCB)
PCB(2) (Power Supply PCB)
PCB(3) (Display PCB)
PCB(4) (Signal Receiver PCB)
1) S6 Connector for swing motor (horizontal swing)
2) S7 Connector for AC fan motor
3) S21 Connector for centralized control
4) S24 Connector for display PCB
5) S26 Connector for signal receiver PCB
6) S32 Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
7) S37 Connector for power supply PCB
1) S36 Connector for control PCB
1) S25 Connector for control PCB
1) S27 Connector for control PCB
2) S31 Connector for room temperature thermistor
1) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function
Refer to page 193 for detail.
2) SW2 Select switch ceiling or floor
3) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
1) V1 Varistor
1) FU1 Fuse (3.15A)
1) LED1 LED for operation (green)
2) LED2 LED for timer (yellow)
3) LED3 LED for HOME LEAVE operation (red)
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON/OFF switch
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 79
PCB Detail PCB (1): Control PCB
PCB Detail PCB (2): Power Supply PCB
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
80 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB (3): Display PCB
PCB (4): Signal Receiver PCB
SW1
PbF
PHOTO
2P084377- 1
SW1
I
RTH
WLU
3
C1
C2
C3
EX511 REV 12
S27
(R4977)
S31(RTH)
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 81
1.6 Floor Standing Type
Connectors PCB(1) (Power Supply PCB)
PCB(2) (Control PCB)
PCB(3) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(4) (Display PCB)
Note: Other Designations
PCB(2) (Control PCB)
PCB(3) (Signal Receiver PCB)
PCB(4) (Display PCB)
1) S8, S202,
S204
Connector for control PCB
1) S6 Connector for swing motor and lower air outlet motor
2) S21 Connector for centralized control
3) S23 Connector for display PCB
4) S31, S32 Connector for room temperature / heat exchanger thermistor
5) S7, S201,
S203
Connector for power supply PCB
6) S25 Connector for signal receiver PCB
7) S301, S302 Connector for DC fan motors
1) S26 Connector for control PCB
1) S24 Connector for control PCB
1) V1 Varistor
2) JA Address setting jumper
JB Fan speed setting when compressor is OFF on thermostat
JC Power failure recovery function
Refer to page 193 for detail.
3) FU Fuse (3.15A)
4) LED A LED for service monitor (green)
1) SW2 Changing upward air flow limit switch
2) SW4 Discharge changeover switch
1) SW1 (S1W) Forced operation ON/OFF switch
2) LED11 LED for operation (green)
3) LED12 LED for timer (yellow)
4) LED14 LED for HOME LEAVE operation (red)
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
82 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB (1): Power Supply PCB
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 83
PCB Detail PCB (2): Control PCB
PCB (3): Signal Receiver PCB
PCB (4): Display PCB
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
84 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.7 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (600600)
Connectors PCB(1)(Control PCB [A1P])
PCB(2)(Signal Receiver PCB [A3P])
PCB(3)(Display PCB [A4P])
Note: Other designation
PCB(1)(Control PCB [A1P])
PCB(2)(Signal Receiver PCB [A3P])
PCB(3)(Display PCB [A4P])
1) X5A Connector for terminal strip (for wired remote controller)
2) X10A, X11A Connector for transformer
3) X15A Connector for float switch
4) X17A, X18A Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
5) X19A Connector for room temperature thermistor
6) X20A Connector for fan motor
7) X24A Connector for signal receiver PCB
(when the wireless remote controller is used)
8) X25A Connector for drain pump motor
9) X27A Connector for terminal strip (for inter unit wiring)
10) X33A Optional connector for wiring adaptor PCB
11) X35A Optional connector for group control adaptor
12) X36A Connector for swing motor
13) X40A Optional connector for ON/OFF input from outside
14) X60A, X61A Optional connector for interface adaptor
1) X1A Connector for display PCB
2) X2A Connector for control PCB
1) X1A Connector for signal receiver PCB
1) HAP Service monitor LED
1) SS2 Address setting switch
1) BS1 Forced operation ON/OFF switch
2) LED1(H1P) LED for operation (red)
3) LED2(H2P) LED for timer (green)
4) LED3(H3P) LED for filter cleaning sign (red)
5) LED4(H4P) LED for defrost operation (orange)
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 85
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB (A1P)
X25A
X18A
X61A
X36A
X40A
X17A
X15A
HAP
(Service
monitor LED)
Capacity
setting
adaptor
X5A X35A X24A
X60A
X19A
X11A
X33A
X10A
X27A
X20A
2P095006
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
86 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(2): Signal Receiver PCB (A3P)
PCB(3): Display PCB (A4P)
X2A
(R4873)
X1A
SS2
LED4
X1A BS1
(R4874)
LED3 LED2 LED1
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 87
1.8 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type (950950)
Connectors PCB(1)(Control PCB [A1P])
PCB(2)(Signal Receiver PCB [A2P])
PCB(3)(Display PCB [A3P])
Note: Other designation
PCB(1)(Control PCB [A1P])
PCB(2)(Signal Receiver PCB [A2P])
PCB(3)(Display PCB [A3P])
1) X5A Connector for terminal strip (for wired remote controller)
2) X10A, X11A Connector for transformer
3) X15A Connector for float switch
4) X17A, X18A Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
5) X19A Connector for room temperature thermistor
6) X20A Connector for fan motor
7) X24A Connector for signal receiver PCB
(when the wireless remote controller is used)
8) X25A Connector for drain pump motor
9) X27A Connector for terminal strip (for inter unit wiring)
10) X33A Optional connector for wiring adaptor PCB
11) X35A Optional connector for group control adaptor
12) X36A Connector for swing motor
13) X60A, X61A Optional connector for interface adaptor
1) X1A Connector for display PCB
2) X2A Connector for control PCB
1) X1A Connector for signal receiver PCB
1) HAP Service monitor LED
1) SS2 Address setting switch
1) BS1 Forced operation ON/OFF switch
2) LED1(H1P) LED for operation (red)
3) LED2(H2P) LED for timer (green)
4) LED3(H3P) LED for filter cleaning sign (red)
5) LED4(H4P) LED for defrost operation (orange)
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
88 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
PCB Detail PCB(1): Control PCB (A1P)
X25A
X18A
X61A
X36A
X17A
X15A
HAP
(Service
monitor LED)
Capacity
setting
adaptor
X5A X35A X24A
X60A
X19A
X11A
X33A
X10A
X27A
X20A
2P095006
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 89
PCB Detail PCB(2): Signal Receiver PCB (A2P)
PCB(3): Display PCB (A3P)
X2A
(R4873)
X1A
SS2
LED3
(R4955)
LED4 X1A
BS1 LED2 LED1
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
90 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.9 Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type
Connectors Control PCB [A1P]
Note: Other designation
Control PCB [A1P]
1) X5A Connector for terminal strip (for wired remote controller)
2) X10A, X11A Connector for transformer
3) X15A Connector for float switch
4) X17A, X18A Connector for heat exchanger thermistor
5) X19A Connector for room temperature thermistor
6) X21A Connector for fan motor
7) X25A Connector for drain pump motor
8) X27A Connector for terminal strip (for inter unit wiring)
9) X33A Optional connector for wiring adaptor PCB
10) X35A Optional connector for group control adaptor
11) X60A, X61A Optional connector for interface adaptor
1) HAP Service monitor LED
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 91
PCB Detail Control PCB (A1P)
X27A
X25A
X11A
X33A
X61A
X15A X18A X19A X17A
X21A
X5A
X10A
X35A
X60A
HAP
2P095008
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
92 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
1.10 Ceiling Suspended Type
Connectors
1) X5A Connector for Terminal Strip (for Wired Remote Controller)
2) X14A Connector for Limit Switch (for Swing Flap)
3) X15A Connector for Drain Pump (Optional Accessory)
4) X17A Connector for Heat Exchanger Thermistor (2)
5) X18A Connector for Heat Exchanger Thermistor (1)
6) X19A Connector for Room Temperature Thermistor
7) X20A, X26A Connector for Fan Motor
8) X24A Connector for Wireless Remote Controller Receiver Unit
9) X25A Connector for Drain Pump Motor (Optional Accessory)
10) X27A Connector for Terminal Strip (for Inter Unit Wiring)
11) X29A Connector for Swing Motor
12) X33A Connector for Wring Adaptor PCB (Optional Accessory)
13) X35A Connector for Group Control Adaptor (Optional Accessory)
14) X40A Connector for ON/OFF Input from Outside (for Optional Accessory)
15) X60A, X61A Connector for Interface Adaptor (Optional Accessory)
Note: Other Designation
1) HAP Service Monitor LED
Si18-525B Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram 93
PCB Detail
Capacity setting
adaptor
X18A X40A X15A X19A
X17A
X14A
X61A
X33A
X27A
X20A
X35A
X60A
X5A
X24A
X26A
X29A
X25A
HAP
(Service
monitor
LED)
2P095007
Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram Si18-525B
94 Printed Circuit Board Connector Wiring Diagram
Si18-525B
Refrigerant Circuit 95
Part 4
Refrigerant Circuit
1. Refrigerant Circuit .................................................................................96
1.1 Outdoor Units .........................................................................................96
1.2 BP Units .................................................................................................98
2. Functional Parts Layout ........................................................................99
2.1 Outdoor Units .........................................................................................99
3. Refrigerant Flow for Each Operation Mode.........................................100
3.1 Cooling Operation ................................................................................100
3.2 Heating Operation ................................................................................101
3.3 Cooling Oil Return Operation ...............................................................102
3.4 Heating Oil Return Operation & Defrost Operation ..............................103
Refrigerant Circuit Si18-525B
96 Refrigerant Circuit
1. Refrigerant Circuit
1.1 Outdoor Units
No. in
refrigerant
system
diagram
Symbol Name Major Function
A M1C Inverter compressor (INV)
Inverter compressor is operated on frequencies between 52 Hz and 190 Hz by using
the inverter.
25 steps
D
M1F
M2F
Inverter fan
Since the system is of air heat exchanging type, the fan is operated at 8-step rotation
speed by using the inverter.
E Y1E
Electronic expansion valve
(Main: EV1)
While in heating operation, PI control is applied to keep the outlet superheated degree
of air heat exchanger constant.
F Y2E
Electronic expansion valve
(Subcool: EV2)
PI control is applied to keep the outlet superheated degree of subcooling heat
exchanger constant.
G Y1S Solenoid valve (Hot gas: SVP) Used to prevent the low pressure from transient falling.
J Y2S
Solenoid valve (Receiver gas
discharging: SVG)
Used to collect refrigerant to receiver.
M Y3S Four way valve Used to switch the operation mode between cooling and heating.
N S1NPH High pressure sensor Used to detect high pressure.
O S1NPL Low pressure sensor Used to detect low pressure.
P S1PH
HP pressure switch (For INV
compressor)
In order to prevent the increase of high pressure when a malfunction occurs, this
switch is activated at high pressure of 4.0 MPa or more to stop the compressor
operation.
S Fusible plug
In order to prevent the increase of pressure when abnormal heating is caused by fire
or others, the fusible part of the plug is molten at a temperature of 70 to 75C to
release the pressure into the atmosphere.
T
Pressure regulating valve 1
(Receiver to discharge pipe)
This valve opens at a pressure of 2.0 to 2.7 MPa for prevention of pressure increase,
thus resulting in no damage of functional parts due to the increase of pressure in
transportation or storage.
1 R1T Thermistor (Outdoor air: Ta) Used to detect outdoor temperature, correct discharge pipe temperature, and others.
2 R2T Thermistor (Suction pipe: Ts)
Used to detect suction pipe temperature, keep the suction superheated degree
constant in heating operation, and others.
3 R3T
Thermistor (INV discharge
pipe: Tdi)
Used to detect discharge pipe temperature, make the temperature protection control of
compressor, and others.
4 R4T
Thermistor (Heat exchanger
deicer: Tb)
Used to detect liquid pipe temperature of air heat exchanger, determine defrosting
operation, and others.
5 R5T
Thermistor (Subcooling heat
exchanger gas pipe: Tsh)
Used to detect gas pipe temperature on the evaporation side of subcooling heat
exchanger, keep the superheated degree at the outlet of subcooling heat exchanger
constant, and others.
Si18-525B Refrigerant Circuit
Refrigerant Circuit 97
Refrigerant Circuit Diagram
F
i
l
t
e
r
L
o
w
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
H
i
g
h
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
F
i
l
t
e
r
C
a
p
i
l
l
a
r
y
t
u
b
e
s
e
n
s
o
r
s
e
n
s
o
r
S P
S
t
o
p
v
a
l
v
e
(
W
i
t
h
s
e
r
v
i
c
e
p
o
r
t
o
n
f
i
e
l
d
p
i
p
i
n
g
s
i
d
e
6
.
4
m
m
f
l
a
r
e
c
o
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
)
S
PF
i
l
t
e
r
S V
O i l
s e p a r a t o r
F
o
u
r
w
a
y
S
o
l
e
n
o
i
d
v
a
l
v
e
S V
P
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
r
e
g
u
l
a
t
i
n
g
v
a
l
v
e
v
a
l
v
e
S
o
l
e
n
o
i
d
v
a
l
v
e
C
o
m
p
r
e
s
s
o
r
F
i
l
t
e
r
C
h
e
c
k
C
h
e
c
k
v
a
l
v
e
v
a
l
v
e
H
P
S
R e c e i v e r
s
w
i
t
c
h
H
i
g
h
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
C
h
e
c
k
C
h
e
c
k
v
a
l
v
e
v
a
l
v
e
e
x
p
a
n
s
i
o
n
v
a
l
v
e
E
l
e
c
t
r
o
n
i
c
F
i
l
t
e
r
H
e
a
t
e
x
c
h
a
n
g
e
r
p
i
p
e
e
x
p
a
n
s
i
o
n
v
a
l
v
e
E
l
e
c
t
r
o
n
i
c
h
e
a
t
e
x
c
h
a
n
g
e
r
D
o
u
b
l
e
p
i
p
e
F
i
l
t
e
r
H
e
a
t
e
x
c
h
a
n
g
e
r
S
e
r
v
i
c
e
p
o
r
t
O
J
S
F
E
D
A
P
T
M
N
G
D
(Q0371)
2
0
0
0
p
l
s
2
0
0
~
4
0
0
p
l
s
E
V
2
F
u
l
l
c
l
o
s
e
S
V
P
O
F
F
O
N
S
V
G
O
N
O
F
F
O
N
O
F
F
E
V
A
:
8
0
p
l
s
E
V
H
:
S
H
c
o
n
t
r
o
l
E
V
B
:
8
0
p
l
s
E
V
H
:
F
u
l
l
c
l
o
s
e
E
V
B
:
8
0
p
l
s
E
V
A
:
S
H
c
o
n
t
r
o
l
E
V
A
:
S
H
c
o
n
t
r
o
l
:
H
i
g
h
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
l
i
q
u
i
d
r
e
f
r
i
g
e
r
a
n
t
:
H
i
g
h
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
h
i
g
h
t
e
m
p
.
g
a
s
r
e
f
r
i
g
e
r
a
n
t
:
L
o
w
p
r
e
s
s
u
r
e
l
o
w
t
e
m
p
.
l
i
q
u
i
d
o
r
g
a
s
r
e
f
r
i
g
e
r
a
n
t
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
F
IE
L
D
P
IP
IN
G
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
"
O
F
F
"
"
O
F
F
"
"
O
F
F
"
"
O
F
F
"
"
O
N
"
"
O
N
"
"
O
N
"
F
I
E
L
D
P
I
P
I
N
G
S
IR
R
O
C
O
F
A
N
F
A
N
M
O
T
O
R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
C
O
M
P
R
E
S
S
O
R
H
I
G
H
P
R
E
S
S
U
R
E
S
E
N
S
O
R
S
P
S P
H
P
S
F
I
L
T
E
R
F
I
L
T
E
R
S
V
P
S
V
G
E
V
1
E
V
2
L
I
Q
U
I
D
L
I
N
E
S
T
O
P
V
A
L
V
E
G
A
S
L
I
N
E
S
T
O
P
V
A
L
V
E
F
I
L
T
E
R
F
I
L
T
E
R
F
I
L
T
E
R
O
I
L
S
E
P
A
R
A
T
O
R
M
O
T
O
R
M
O
T
O
R
D
C
F
A
N
D
C
F
A
N
D
I
S
T
R
I
B
U
T
O
R
P
R
O
P
E
L
L
E
R
M M
F
A
N
4
-
W
A
Y
V
A
L
V
E
H
I
G
H
P
R
E
S
S
U
R
E
S
W
I
T
C
H
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
T
H
E
R
M
I
S
T
O
R
O
U
T
D
O
O
R
A
I
R
T
H
E
R
M
I
S
T
O
R
C
A
P
I
L
L
A
R
Y
T
U
B
E
L
O
W
P
R
E
S
S
U
R
E
S
E
N
S
O
R
R E C E I V E R
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
P
I
P
E
E
L
E
C
T
R
O
N
I
C
E
X
P
A
N
S
I
O
N
V
A
L
V
E
E
L
E
C
T
R
O
N
I
C
E
X
P
A
N
S
I
O
N
V
A
L
V
E
C
H
E
C
K
V
A
L
V
E
C
H
E
C
K
V
A
L
V
E
C
H
E
C
K
V
A
L
V
E
C
H
E
C
K
V
A
L
V
E
D
O
U
B
L
E
P
I
P
E
H
E
A
T
E
X
C
H
A
N
G
E
R
L
I
Q
U
I
D
S
E
A
L
P
R
O
T
E
C
T
I
O
N
C
H
E
C
K
V
A
L
V
E
Refrigerant Flow for Each Operation Mode Si18-525B
104 Refrigerant Circuit
Si18-525B
Function 105
Part 5
Function
1. Operation Mode ..................................................................................107
2. Basic Control .......................................................................................108
2.1 Normal Operation.................................................................................108
2.2 Compressor PI Control .........................................................................109
2.3 Electronic Expansion Valve PI Control .................................................112
2.4 Cooling Operation Fan Control.............................................................113
3. Special Control ....................................................................................114
3.1 Startup Control .....................................................................................114
3.2 Oil Return Operation ............................................................................115
3.3 Defrosting Operation ............................................................................117
3.4 Pump-down Residual Operation ..........................................................118
3.5 Restart Standby....................................................................................118
3.6 Stopping Operation ..............................................................................119
3.7 Pressure Equalization Prior to Startup .................................................119
4. Protection Control ...............................................................................120
4.1 High Pressure Protection Control .........................................................120
4.2 Low Pressure Protection Control..........................................................122
4.3 Discharge Pipe Protection Control .......................................................123
4.4 Inverter Protection Control ...................................................................124
4.5 Freeze-up Protection Control ...............................................................125
4.6 Dew Condensation Prevention Control ................................................126
5. Other Control.......................................................................................127
5.1 Demand Operation...............................................................................127
5.2 Heating Operation Prohibition ..............................................................127
6. BP Unit Control ...................................................................................128
6.1 BP Unit Command Conversion ............................................................128
6.2 BP Unit Electronic Expansion Valve Control ........................................129
6.3 SH Control in Cooling Operation..........................................................131
6.4 SC Control in Heating Operation..........................................................132
6.5 Heat Exchanger Isothermal Control in Heating Operation ...................132
7. Indoor Unit (RA Models)......................................................................133
7.1 Power-Airflow Dual Flaps, Wide Angle Louvers and Auto-Swing ........133
7.2 Fan Speed Control for Indoor Units......................................................134
7.3 Programme Dry Function .....................................................................135
7.4 Automatic Operation.............................................................................136
7.5 Thermostat Control...............................................................................137
7.6 Night Set Mode.....................................................................................138
7.7 ECONO Mode ......................................................................................139
7.8 MOLD PROOF Operation ....................................................................139
7.9 INTELLIGENT EYE..............................................................................140
7.10 HOME LEAVE Operation .....................................................................142
7.11 Inverter POWERFUL Operation...........................................................143
7.12 Other Functions....................................................................................144
Si18-525B
106 Function
8. Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) ................................................................146
8.1 Function Outline ...................................................................................146
8.2 Electric Function Parts .........................................................................147
8.3 Function Details....................................................................................148
Si18-525B Operation Mode
Function 107
1. Operation Mode
Operation in
stop mode
Pressure
equalization
prior to startup
Startup control
Cooling startup
control
Heating startup
control
Oil return IN
conditions are met.
Operation
mode change
Oil return operation
Pump-down
residual
operation
Restart standby
(Compressor stop)
Yes
Yes
No
No
Malfunction/Standby
Indoor unit stop or
thermostat OFF
Normal operation
Compressor PI control
Electronic expansion
valve PI control
Protection control
Indoor unit thermostat ON
without mode change
Defrost IN
conditions are met.
No
Yes
Defrosting operation
Cooling or heating
operation
BP unit
cooling: SH control
heating: SC control
Indoor unit thermostat ON
Indoor unit stop or
thermostat OFF
Indoor unit stop or
thermostat OFF
Malfunction/
Standby
Malfunction/
Standby
Note:
In the event indoor unit stops or the thermostat
turns OFF while in oil return operation or
defrosting operation, pump-down residual
operation is performed on completion of the oil
return operation or defrosting operation.
Malfunction/Standby
(Q0372)
Basic Control Si18-525B
108 Function
2. Basic Control
2.1 Normal Operation
Cooling Operation
Heating Operation
Heating operation is not functional at an outdoor air temperature of 30CDB or more.
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor Compressor PI control
Used for high pressure protection control, low
pressure protection control, discharge pipe
temperature protection control, compressor
operating frequency upper limit control with
inverter protection control, dew prevention control,
and freeze-up protection control.
Outdoor unit fan Cooling fan control
Four way valve OFF
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 2000 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
PI control
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF
This valve turns on with low pressure protection
control.
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) OFF This valve turns on with dew prevention control.
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(operating room)
SH control
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(stopping room)
0 pls
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor Compressor PI control
Used for high pressure protection control, low
pressure protection control, discharge pipe
temperature protection control, and compressor
operating frequency upper limit control with
inverter protection control.
Outdoor unit fan STEP8
The fan step changes to STEP1 with high pressure
> 3.2MPa.
Four way valve ON
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) PI control
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
The opening of this valve changes with high
pressure > 3.2MPa.
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF
This valve turns on with low pressure protection
control.
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) OFF
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(operating room)
SC control
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(stopping room)
80 pls
The opening of this valve changes with insufficient
gas control.
Si18-525B Basic Control
Function 109
2.2 Compressor PI Control
Compressor PI Control
Carries out the compressor capacity PI control to maintain Te at constant during cooling
operation and Tc at constant during heating operation to ensure stable unit performance.
[Cooling operation]
Te changes corresponding to the capacity which indoor units require the above as the initial
value. (However -7 Te 15)
[Heating operation]
Tc changes corresponding to the capacity which indoor units require the above as the initial
value. (However 42 Tc 51)
Controls compressor capacity to adjust Te to
achieve target value (TeS).
Te : Low pressure equivalent saturation
temperature (C)
TeS initial value TeS : Target Te value
(Varies depending on Te setting, operating
frequency, etc.) Condition L
M (Normal)
(factory setting)
H
D up 3 6 9
D keep 12 12 12
D down 12 12 13
Controls compressor capacity to adjust Tc to
achieve target value (TcS).
Tc : High pressure equivalent saturation
temperature (C)
TcS initial value TcS : Target Tc value
(Varies depending on Tc setting, operating
frequency, etc.)
L M (Normal)
(factory
setting)
H
43 46 49
RMK(X)S112 140 160D, RMKD112 140 160D
STEP INV
1 52Hz
2 57Hz
3 62Hz
4 68Hz
5 74Hz
6 80Hz
7 86Hz
8 92Hz
9 98Hz
10 104Hz
11 111Hz
12 118Hz
13 124Hz
14 129Hz
15 134Hz
STEP INV
16 140Hz
17 146Hz
18 152Hz
19 158Hz
20 164Hz
21 170Hz
22 175Hz
23 180Hz
24 185Hz
25 190Hz
Compressors may operate in a pattern other than those listed in above tables subject to the operating conditions.
Basic Control Si18-525B
110 Function
D Control Receiving the capacity request signal from the indoor unit, the outdoor unit corrects its target
pressure for capacity control.
Controls D signal from indoor unit as follows.
UP control: When the UP command come from more than one indoor unit among
thermostat-ON indoor units.
Down control: When the down command come from all indoor units among thermostat-ON
indoor units.
Keep control: Except for the above
About detail of D signal, refer to P128
Cooling Operation
TeS = TeS initial value + KTe2
KTe2 : Correction value by D signal in cooling.
KTe2 = 0
(without correction)
D control
Keep the current KTe2
KTe2 = KTe2 + 0.5 KTe2 = KTe2 + 0.5
Up control by D signal
continues 120 sec.
Down control by D signal
continues 120 sec.
During compressor frequency PI
control (KTe2 = 0)
Not during compressor frequency PI
control
(Q0396)
Si18-525B Basic Control
Function 111
Heating Operation
TcS = TcS initial value + KTc2
KTc2 : Correction value by D signal in heating.
KTc2 = 0
(without correction)
D control
Keep the current KTc2
KTc2 = KTc2 + 0.5 KTc2 = KTc2 - 0.5
Up control by D signal
continues 120 sec.
Down control by D signal
continues 120 sec.
During compressor frequency PI
control (KTc2 = 0)
Not during compressor frequency PI
control
(Q0397)
Basic Control Si18-525B
112 Function
2.3 Electronic Expansion Valve PI Control
Main Electronic Expansion Valve EV1 Control
Carries out the electronic expansion valve (Y1E) PI control to maintain the evaporator outlet
superheated degree (SH) at constant during heating operation to make maximum use of the
outdoor unit heat exchanger (evaporator).
The optimum initial value of the evaporator outlet superheated degree is 5C, but varies
depending on the discharge pipe superheated degree of inverter compressor.
Subcooling Electronic Expansion Valve EV2 Control
Makes PI control of the electronic expansion valve (Y2E) to keep the superheated degree (SH)
of the outlet gas pipe on the evaporator side for the full use of the subcooling heat exchanger.
SH = Ts - Te SH : Evaporator outlet superheated degree (C)
Ts : Suction pipe temperature detected by thermistor
R2T (C)
Te : Low pressure equivalent saturation temperature
(C)
SH = Tsh -Te SH : Outlet superheated degree of evaporator (C)
Tsh : Suction pipe temperature detected with the
thermistor R5T (C)
Te : Low pressure equivalent saturation temperature
(C)
Si18-525B Basic Control
Function 113
2.4 Cooling Operation Fan Control
In cooling operation with low outdoor air temperature, this control is used to provide the
adequate amount of circulation air with liquid pressure secured by high pressure control using
outdoor unit fan.
Outline In cooling operation fan control, outdoor unit fans are controlled by PI control to come the
cooling Tc to 34C.
However in normal operation, the fan control restricts lower limit of the number of rotations
according to outdoor air temperature.
Lower Limit Restriction for Cooling Operation Fan Control
Lower limit
STEP7
Ta17C Ta20C
Lower limit
STEP5
Ta15C Ta18C
Lower limit
STEP1
Ta9C Ta12C
Ta: Outdoor air temperature
No limitation
850rpm
715rpm
580rpm
445rpm
360rpm
285rpm
400rpm
250rpm
0 rpm
M1F
815rpm
680rpm
545rpm
410rpm
325rpm
250rpm
0 rpm
0 rpm
0 rpm
M2F
STEP3
STEP4
STEP5
STEP6
STEP7
STEP8
STEP2
STEP1
STEP0
Cooling
Fan Steps
850rpm
250rpm
815rpm
M1F
0 rpm
M2F
STEP8*
STEP1
Heating
There are 2 steps in heating operation.
* Depends on models
Reference
(Q0373)
Special Control Si18-525B
114 Function
3. Special Control
3.1 Startup Control
On activation, following control is performed to lighten load of the compressor by back liquid and
the like. Also, the position of the four way valve is defined.
3.1.1 Startup Control in Cooling Operation
3.1.2 Startup Control in Heating Operation
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor Differential pressure control
Compressor operating frequency
increases by 2 step / 20 sec until
Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa.
Outdoor unit fan High pressure control
Initial fan speed is set to STEP 0
(Ta<20C), or STEP 7 (Ta).
Four way valve OFF
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 2000 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) ON
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) OFF
Ending conditions
255 sec.
Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa
75 sec
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(operating room)
0 pls
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(stopping room)
0 pls
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor Differential pressure control
Compressor operating frequency
increases by 2 step / 20 sec until
Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa.
Outdoor unit fan STEP8
Four way valve ON
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 180 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) ON
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) ON
Ending conditions
225 sec.
Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa
40 sec
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(operating room)
0 pls
BP unit electronic expansion valve
(stopping room)
0 pls
or
&(
or
&(
Si18-525B Special Control
Function 115
3.2 Oil Return Operation
Oil flown from the compressor to the side of system is collected by oil-returning operation, in
case of that oil in the compressor runs down.
3.2.1 Oil Return Operation in Cooling Operation
[Conditions to start]
The cooling oil-returning operation is started referring following conditions.
Integrated amount of displaced oil
Timer
(After the power is turned on, integrated operating-time is 2 hours and subsequently every 8
hours.)
In addition, integrated amount of displaced oil is derived from Tc, Te, and the compressor
load.
Outdoor unit actuator
Oil return preparation
operation
Oil return operation Post-oil-return operation
Compressor Upper limit control 124 Hz 124 Hz
Outdoor unit fan Fan control Fan control Fan control
Four way valve OFF OFF OFF
Main electronic expansion valve
(EV1)
2000 pls 2000 pls 2000 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion
valve (EV2)
SH control 0 pls 0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF ON ON
Receiver gas discharging valve
(SVG)
OFF OFF OFF
Ending conditions 20 sec.
6 min.
Ts - Te<5
3 min. or
Indoor actuator Cooling oil return operation
Indoor unit fan
Thermostat ON unit Set Air Volume
Stopping unit OFF
Thermostat OFF unit Set Air Volume
BP unit electronic expansion
valve
Thermostat ON unit SH control
Stopping unit 56 pls
Thermostat OFF unit SH control
Special Control Si18-525B
116 Function
3.2.2 Oil Return Operation in Heating Operation
[Conditions to start]
The heating oil-returning operation is started referring following conditions.
Integrated amount of displaced oil
Timer
(After the power is turned on, integrated operating-time is 2 hours and subsequently every 8
hours.)
In addition, integrated amount of displaced oil is derived from Tc, Te, and the compressor
load.
* From the preparing oil-returning operation to the oil-returning operation, and from the oil-
returning operation to the operation after oil-returning, the compressor stops for 1 minute to
reduce noise on changing of the four way valve.
Outdoor Unit Actuator
Oil return preparation
operation
Oil return operation Post-oil-return operation
Compressor Upper limit control 124 Hz
2-step increase from
52 Hz to
(Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa) time
Outdoor unit fan STEP8 High pressure control STEP8
Four way valve ON OFF ON
Main electronic expansion valve
(EV1)
SH control 2000 pls 200~400 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion
valve (EV2)
0 pls 0 pls 0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF ON ON
Receiver gas discharging valve
(SVG)
ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Ending conditions 130 sec.
Max. 735 sec.
Ts - Te<5
160 sec.
Pc - Pe>0.4MPa
or or
Indoor actuator Heating oil return operation
Indoor unit fan
Thermostat ON unit OFF
Stopping unit OFF
Thermostat OFF unit OFF
BP unit electronic expansion
valve
Thermostat ON unit SH control
Stopping unit 80 pls
Thermostat OFF unit SH control
Si18-525B Special Control
Function 117
3.3 Defrosting Operation
The defrost operation is performed to solve frost on the outdoor unit heat exchanger when
heating, and the heating capacity is recovered.
[Conditions to start]
The defrost operation is started referring following conditions.
Outdoor heat exchanger heat transfer co-efficiency
Temperature of heat-exchange (Tb)
Low pressure equivalent saturation temperature (Te)
Timer (2 hours at the minimum)
In addition, outdoor heat-exchange co-efficiency is derived from Tc, Te, and the compressor
load.
* From the preparing operation to the defrost operation, and from the defrost operation to the
operation after defrost, the compressor stops for 110 sec. to reduce noise on changing of the
four way valve.
Outdoor unit actuator
Defrost preparation
operation
Defrost operation Post Defrost operation
Compressor Upper limit control 140 Hz
2-step increase from
52 Hz to
(Pc - Pe>0.4 MPa)
every 20 sec.
Outdoor unit fan STEP8 OFF STEP8
Four way valve ON OFF ON
Main electronic expansion valve
(EV1)
SH control 2000 pls 200~400 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion
valve (EV2)
0 pls 0 pls 0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF ON ON
Receiver gas discharging valve
(SVG)
ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Ending conditions 130 sec.
Max. 18 min.
Tb >11C
160 sec.
Pc - Pe>0.4MPa
or or
Indoor actuator During defrost
Indoor unit fan
Thermostat ON unit OFF
Stopping unit OFF
Thermostat OFF unit OFF
BP unit electronic expansion
valve
Thermostat ON unit SH control
Stopping unit 80 pls
Thermostat OFF unit SH control
Special Control Si18-525B
118 Function
3.4 Pump-down Residual Operation
When activating compressor, if the liquid refrigerant remains in the heat-exchanger, the liquid
enters into the compressor and dilutes oil therein resulting in decrease of lubricity.
Therefore, the pump-down residual operation is performed to collect the refrigerant in the heat-
exchanger when the compressor is down.
3.4.1 Pump-down Residual Operation in Cooling Operation
3.4.2 Pump-down Residual Operation in Heating Operation
3.5 Restart Standby
Restart is stood by force to prevent frequent power-on/off and to equalize pressure in the
refrigerant system.
Actuator Outdoor unit operation
Compressor 124 Hz
Outdoor unit fan Fan control
Four way valve OFF
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 2000 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) ON OFF
Ending conditions
30 sec.
Pe<0.5 MPa
Td>110C
or
Actuator Outdoor unit operation
Compressor 52 124 Hz
Outdoor unit fan STEP8
Four way valve ON
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 0 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) ON OFF
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) ON OFF
Ending conditions
3 min.
Pe<0.25 MPa
Td>110C
or
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor OFF
Outdoor unit fan OFF
Four way valve Keep former condition.
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 0 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve
(EV2)
0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF ON
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) OFF
Ending conditions 5 min.
Si18-525B Special Control
Function 119
3.6 Stopping Operation
3.6.1 When System is in Stop Mode
3.7 Pressure Equalization Prior to Startup
Before activating the compressor, the activation load is lightened by equalization across the
compressor. In addition, inverters turn on electricity and capacitors are charged.
Actuator Operation
Compressor OFF
Outdoor unit fan OFF
Four way valve Keep former condition.
Main electronic expansion valve (EV1) 0 pls
Subcooling electronic expansion valve (EV2) 0 pls
Hot gas bypass valve (SVP) OFF
Receiver gas discharging valve (SVG) OFF
Ending conditions Indoor unit thermostat is turned ON.
Actuator Operation Remarks
Compressor OFF
Outdoor unit fan
Cooling: STEP7
Heating: Ta>26C; STEP8,
Ta26C; OFF
50
(R4282)
30
65
(R4283)
5
70
(R4284)
4
5
4
5
(R1024)
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
134 Function
7.2 Fan Speed Control for Indoor Units
Control Mode The airflow rate can be automatically controlled depending on the difference between the set
temperature and the room temperature. This is done through phase control and Hall IC control.
For more information about Hall IC, refer to the troubleshooting for fan motor on page 332.
Phase Steps Phase control and fan speed control contains 9 steps: LLL, LL, SL, L, ML, M, MH, H and HH.
= Within this range the airflow rate is automatically controlled when the FAN setting
button is set to automatic.
Note: 1. During powerful operation, fan rotates at H tap + 50 - 90 rpm.
2. Fan stops during defrost operation.
Automatic Air
Flow Control for
Heating
On heating mode, the indoor fan speed will be regulated according to the indoor heat exchanger
temperature and the difference between the room temperature and the required set point.
Automatic Air
Flow Control for
Cooling
The following drawing explains the principle of fan speed control for cooling:
Step Cooling Heating Dry mode
LLL
20 25 35kW class :
670 - 880 rpm
(During powerful operation :
720 - 930 rpm)
50 60 71kW class :
750 - 1000 rpm
(During powerful operation :
1050 rpm)
LL
SL (Silent)
L
ML
M
MH
H
HH (Powerful)
(R2818) (R2818)
+1.5C
+0.5C
+2C
+1C
M
ML
L
fan speed
Difference between room
and set temperature
Thermostat
setting
temperature
(R4594)
DC motor: Rotation speed control
AC motor: Phase control
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 135
7.3 Programme Dry Function
Programme dry function removes humidity while preventing the room temperature from
lowering.
Since the microcomputer controls both the temperature and air flow volume, the temperature
adjustment and fan adjustment buttons are inoperable in this mode.
In Case of
Inverter Units
The microcomputer automatically sets the temperature and fan settings. The difference
between the room temperature at startup and the temperature set by the microcomputer is
divided into two zones. Then, the unit operates in the dry mode with an appropriate capacity for
each zone to maintain the temperature and humidity at a comfortable level.
Room temperature at
startup
Set temperature
X
Thermostat OFF point
Y
Thermostat ON point
Z
24C or more
Room temperature at
startup
X 2.5C
X 0.5C
or
Y + 0.5C (zone B)
continues for 10 min.
23.5C
X 2.0C
X 0.5C
or
Y + 0.5C (zone B)
continues for 10 min.
~
18C
18C X 2.0C
X 0.5C = 17.5C
or
Y + 0.5C (zone B)
continues for 10 min.
17.5C
~
Z
Y
Zone B
Zone B
Zone A = Thermostat OFF
Zone C = Thermostat ON
+0.5C
(R6841)
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
136 Function
7.4 Automatic Operation
Automatic Cooling / Heating Function (Heat Pump Only)
When the AUTO mode is selected with the remote controller, the microcomputer automatically
determines the operation mode from cooling and heating according to the room temperature
and setting temperature at the time of the operation startup, and automatically operates in that
mode.
The unit automatically switches the operation mode to cooling or heating to maintain the room
temperature at the main unit setting temperature.
Detailed
Explanation of
the Function
1. Remote controller setting temperature is set as automatic cooling / heating setting
temperature (18 to 30C).
2. Main unit setting temperature equals remote controller setting temperature.
3. Mode switching point are as follows.
Heating Cooling switching point:
Room temperature Main unit setting temperature +2.5 deg.
Cooling Heating switching point:
Room temperature < Main unit setting temperature 2.5 deg.
Thermostat ON / OFF point is the same as the ON / OFF point of cooling or heating
operation.
4. During initial operation
Room temperature Remote controller setting temperature: Cooling operation
Room temperature < Remote controller setting temperature: Heating operation
Ex: When the set point is 25C
Cooling Operation 23C: Thermostat OFF 22C: Switch to Heating Operation
Heating Operation 26.5C: Thermostat OFF 27.5C: Switch to Cooling Operation
(R6842)
Setpoint +2.5C
Setpoint 2.0C
=Thermostat OFF
Setpoint +1.5C
=Thermostat OFF
Heating Operation
Setpoint 2.5C
Cooling Operation
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 137
7.5 Thermostat Control
Thermostat control is based on the difference between the room temperature and the setpoint.
Thermostat OFF Condition
The temperature difference is in the zone A.
Thermostat ON Condition
The temperature difference is above the zone C after being in the zone A.
The system resumes from defrost control in any zones except A.
The operation turns on in any zones except A.
The monitoring time has passed while the temperature difference is in the zone B.
(Cooling / Dry : 10 minutes, Heating : 10 seconds)
Cooling / Dry
Heating
B
A
OFF
ON
C
Cooling : 0.5C
Dry : 0.5C
Room temperature - setpoint
Cooling : 2.0C
Dry : 2.5 ~ 2.0C
(R4668)
B
A
OFF
ON
C
1.5C
Room temperature - setpoint
0C
(R4669)
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
138 Function
7.6 Night Set Mode
When the OFF timer is set, the Night Set circuit automatically activates.
The Night Set circuit maintains the airflow setting made by users.
The Night Set
Circuit
The Night Set circuit continues heating or cooling the room at the set temperature for the first
one hour, then automatically raises the temperature setting slightly in the case of cooling, or
lowers it slightly in the case of heating, for economical operations. This prevents excessive
heating in winter and excessive cooling in summer to ensure comfortable sleeping conditions,
and also conserves electricity.
Cooling
Operation
In case of FTK(X)S20-35D, the temperature rises once.
Heating
Operation
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 139
7.7 ECONO Mode
Outline FTK(X)S20-35D, FTKD25-35D
The "ECONO mode" reduces the maximum operating current and power consumption by
approx. 30% during start up etc..
This mode is particularly convenient for energy-saving-oriented users. It is also a major bonus
for those whose breaker capacities do not allow the use of multiple electrical devices and air
conditioners.
It is easily activated from the wireless remote controller by pushing the ECONO button.
When this function is ON, the maximum capacity is also down. (Approx. 20%)
This function can only be set when the unit is running. Pressing the operation stop button
causes the settings to be canceled.
This function and POWERFUL operation cannot be used at the same time. The latest
command has the priority.
Details ECONO mode can be activated while the unit is running. The remote controller can send the
ECONO command when the unit is in COOL, HEAT, DRY, or AUTO operation.
When the ECONO command is valid, the upper limit of frequency is restricted.
7.8 MOLD PROOF Operation
FTK(X)S20-35D, FTKD25-35D
MOLD PROOF operation is a function which reduces the spread of mold by using Fan mode to
lower the humidity inside the indoor unit.
Outline MOLD PROOF operation starts when the following conditions are met.
1. MOLD PROOF is set on the remote controller.
2. Cooling or dry operation stops.
MOLD PROOF operation will operate for approximately one hour after dry or cooling mode
is turned off.
The indoor fan rotates at 550 rpm.
Note: 1. This function is not designed to remove existing dust or mold.
2. MOLD PROOF operation is not available when the unit is turned off using the OFF TIMER.
Econo Mode
(R4607)
Power
consumption
and current
Normal
Time
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
140 Function
7.9 INTELLIGENT EYE
This is the function that detects existence of humans in the room by a human motion sensor
(INTELLIGENT EYE) and reduces the capacity when there is no human in the room in order to
save electricity.
Processing 1. Detection method by Intelligent Eye
This sensor detects human motion by receiving infrared rays and displays the pulse wave
output.
A microcomputer in an indoor unit carries out a sampling every 20 msec. and if it detects 10
cycles of the wave in one second in total (corresponding to 20msec. 10 = 100msec.), it
judges human is in the room as the motion signal is ON.
2. The motions (for example: in cooling)
When a microcomputer doesnt have a signal from the sensor in 20 minutes, it judges that
nobody is in the room and operates the unit in temperature shifted 2C from the set
temperature. (Cooling : 2C higher, Dry: 1C higher and Auto : according to the operation
mode at that time.)
1In case of Fan mode, the fan speed reduces by 50 rpm.
If the sensor detects the outputs 10 times/sec.
or more, it judges humans exist.
1sec
sampling (20msec)
High
Low
ON
OFF
Sensor output
(Human motion)
Human detection
signal
(R2821)
ON
OFF
RESET.
Cooling : Set temp. + 2C
Heating : Set temp. - 2C
Human detection
signal
20 min. 20 min.
within 20
minutes.
40 min.
MaxHz
Mi nHz
0Hz
Compressor
speed
The lower limit by detecting
human.
(Prohibition of thermostat-off)
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Operation
OFF
Fan speed (1)
Set speed - 50 rpm
Set speed Set speed
in case of
thermostat-off
Frequency at set temp. + 2C
Set temp.
(R2822)
Remote controller
Intelligent Eye
button
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 141
Since the set temperature is shifted by 2C higher for 40 minutes, compressor speed
becomes low and can realize energy saving operation. But as thermostat is prone to be off
by the fact that the set temperature has been shifted, the thermostat-off action is prohibited
in 40 minutes so as to prevent this phenomena.
After this 40 minutes, the prohibition of the thermostat-off is cancelled and it can realize the
conditions to conduct thermostat-off depending on the room temperature. In or after this 40
minutes, if the sensor detects human motion detection signal, it let the set temperature and
the fan speed return to the original set point, keeping a normal operation.
Others The dry operation cant command the setting temperature with a remote controller, but
internally the set temperature is shifted by 1C.
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
142 Function
7.10 HOME LEAVE Operation
Outline In order to respond to the customer's need for immediate heating and cooling of the room after
returning home or for house care, a measure to switch the temperature and air volume from that
for normal time over to outing time by one touch is provided. (This function responds also to the
need for keeping up with weak cooling or heating.)
This time, we seek for simplicity of operation by providing the special temperature and air
volume control for outing to be set by the exclusive button.
Detail of the
Control
1. Start of Function
The function starts when the [HOME LEAVE] button is pressed in cooling mode or heating
mode (including stopping and powerful operation). If this button is pressed while the operation is
stopped, the function becomes effective when the operation is started. If this button is pressed
in powerful operation, the powerful operation is reset and this function becomes effective.
The [HOME LEAVE] button is ineffective in dry mode and fan mode.
2. Details of Function
A mark representing [HOME LEAVE] is indicated on the liquid crystal display of the remote
controller. The indoor unit is operated according to the set temperature and air volume for
HOME LEAVE which were pre-set in the memory of the remote controller.
The LED (Red) of indoor unit representing [HOME LEAVE] lights up. (It goes out when the
operation is stopped.)
3. End of Function
The function ends when the [HOME LEAVE] button is pressed again during [HOME LEAVE]
operation or when the powerful operation button is pressed.
Others The set temperature and set air volume are memorized in the remote controller. When the
remote controller is reset due to replacement of battery, it is necessary to set the temperature
and air volume again for [HOME LEAVE].
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 143
7.11 Inverter POWERFUL Operation
Outline In order to exploit the cooling and heating capacity to full extent, operate the air conditioner by
increasing the indoor fan rotating speed and the compressor frequency.
Details of the
Control
When POWERFUL button is pushed in each operation mode, the fan speed / setting
temperature will be converted to the following states in a period of twenty minutes.
In case of FTK(X)S20-35D
Ex.) : Powerful operation in cooling mode.
Operation mode Fan speed Target set temperature
COOL H tap + 50 rpm 18C
DRY Dry rotating speed +
50 rpm
Normally targeted
temperature in dry
operation; Approx. 2C
HEAT H tap + 50 rpm 30C
FAN H tap + 50 rpm
AUTO Same as cooling /
heating in Powerful
operation
The target is kept
unchanged
(R4560)
Target temp.
Fan
50rpm
Set temp.
18C
Powerful ON
Powerful OFF
H tap
Set tap
It should be the lower limit of cooling temperature.
It counts 20 min. also in the remote controller.
20min.
Ending condition: "or" in 1 to 3
1. After the lapse of 20 minutes.
2. Stop
3. Powerful operation is OFF.
Indoor Unit (RA Models) Si18-525B
144 Function
7.12 Other Functions
7.12.1 Hot Start Function
Heat Pump Only
In order to prevent the cold air blast that normally comes when heating is started, the
temperature of the heat exchanger of the indoor unit is detected, and either the air flow is
stopped or is made very weak thereby carrying out comfortable heating of the room.
*The cold air blast is also prevented using a similar control when the defrosting operation is
started or when the thermostat gets turned ON.
7.12.2 Signal Receiving Sign
When the indoor unit receives a signal from the remote controller, the unit emits a signal
receiving sound.
7.12.3 ON/OFF Button on Indoor Unit
An ON/OFF button is provided on the front panel of the unit. Use this button when the remote
controller is missing or if its battery has run out.
Every press of the button switches from ON to OFF or from OFF to ON.
In case of FTK(X)S20-35D, FTKD25-35D
Push this button once to start operation. Push once again to stop it.
This button is useful when the remote controller is missing.
The operation mode refers to the following table.
In the case of multi system operation, there are times when the unit does not activate with
this button.
7.12.4 Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter
For FTK(X)S20-35D, FTKD50-71F
This filter combines the Air Purifying Filter and Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Deodorizing
Filter in a single highly effective unit. The filter traps microscopic particles, decompose odours
and even deactivates bacteria and viruses. It lasts for three years without replacement if
washed about once every six months.
7.12.5 Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
For FTKD25/35D, FTK50-71A, FLXS25-60B, FVXS35/50B
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter demonstrates powerful oxidation characteristics when
subjected to harmless ultraviolet light. Photocatalytic deodorizing power is recovered simply by
exposing the filter to the sun for 6 hours once every 6 months.
7.12.6 Air-Purifying Filter
For FTKD25/35D, FTK50-71A, FLXS25-60B, FVXS35/50B
A double structure made up of a bacteriostatic filter and an Air-Purifying Filter traps dust,
mildew, mites, tobacco smoke, and allergy-causing pollen. Replace the Air-Purifying Filter once
every 3 months.
(R4269)
ON/OFF ON/OFF button
Mode Temperature setting Air flow rate
Cooling Only COOL 22C AUTO
Heat Pump AUTO 25C AUTO
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (RA Models)
Function 145
7.12.7 Air Purifying Filter with Photocatalytic Deodorizing Function
For FTK(X)S50-71B, FTXS50-71D
This filter incorporates the benefits the Air Purifying Filter and Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter
in a single unit. Combining the two filters in this way increases the active surface area of the
new filter. This larger surface area allows the filter to effectively trap microscopic particles,
decompose odours and deactivate bacteria and viruses even for the high volume of air required
to air-condition large living rooms. The filter can be used for approximately 3 years if periodic
maintenance is performed.
7.12.8 Mold Proof Air Filter (Prefilter)
For all indoor units
The filter net is treated with mold resisting agent TBZ (harmless, colorless, and odorless). Due
to this treatment, the amount of mold growth is much smaller than that of normal filters.
7.12.9 Self-Diagnosis Digital Display
The microcomputer continuously monitors main operating conditions of the indoor unit, outdoor
unit and the entire system. When an abnormality occur, the LCD remote controller displays error
code. These indications allow prompt maintenance operations.
7.12.10Auto-restart Function
Even if a power failure (including one for just a moment) occurs during the operation, the
operation restarts in the condition before power failure automatically when power is restored.
(Note) It takes 3 minutes to restart the operation because the 3 minute stand-by function is
activated
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
146 Function
8. Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
8.1 Function Outline
FFQ-B, FCQ-B
FBQ-B, FHQ-B
Indoor Unit
Suction Sensor(R1T)
Heat Exchanger Sensor
(R2T)
Heat Exchanger Sensor
(R3T)
(Output) (Input)
Two thermostats used, suction
and remote controller.
Optional for FHQ
Only for FHQ
Float Switch
No. of Fan Turns
Only for FHQ
Wireless units only
Limit Switch for Flap
(Not provided for wireless
remote controller.)
Remote Controller
Sensor
Emergency Operation
Switch
Remote Controller with
Liquid Crystal
ON/OFF
Air flow direction,
Fan speed, etc.
Thermostat Control
Monitoring Function
Cool/Heat Automatic
Function
Program Dry
Fan Operation
Drain Pump Control
Freeze-up Protection
Function
Heating Overload Control
Defrosting
Indoor Unit Fan Control
Phase control
Cold Air Prevention
Function
Flap Control
Operation Mode Guard
Function
Malfunction Detection
Function
Ceiling Soiling Prevention
Function
Fan Motor
Drain Pump
Optional for FHQ
Wireless units only
Flap Motor
LED Display
Buzzer, LED
(S2540)
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
Function 147
8.2 Electric Function Parts
FFQ B
FCQ B
FBQ B
FHQ B
Capacity 25 35 50 60 Remarks
Wired remote controller BRC1C61 Optional
Accessory
Wireless remote
controller
Heat pump BRC7E530W
Optional
Accessory
Cooling only BRC7E531W
Electronic control unit [2P095006-2] EC0226
Fan motor [3P104408-1] 4P 55W
Fan motor capacitor 4.0F AC440V
Float switch [3P079543-1] FS-0211B
Drain pump [3P103929-1]
PLD-12230DM-17
Capacity 35 50 60 71 Remarks
Wired remote controller BRC1C61 Optional
accessory
Wireless remote
controller
Heat pump BRC7C612W Optional
accessory
Cooling only BRC7C613W
Electronic control unit [2P095006-6] EC0226
Fan motor [3P012316-1] 6P 45W
Fan motor capacitor 3.5F AC440V
Float switch [3P079543-1] FS-0211B
Drain pump [3P011376-1] PLD-12230DM-11
Capacity 60 71 Remarks
Wired remote controller BRC1C61 Optional
accessory
Electronic control unit [2P095008-1] EC0228
Fan motor capacitor 5.0F AC440V
Float switch [3P079543-1] FS-0211B
Drain pump [3P016844-2] PJV-1403
Capacity 35 50 60 Remarks
Wired remote controller BRC1C61 Optional
Accessory
Wireless remote
controller
Heat pump BRC7E63W
Optional
Accessory
Cooling only BRC7E66
Electronic control unit [2P095007-1] EC0227
Fan motor [3PN04213-1] 4P 62W
Fan motor capacitor 3.0F AC440V
Swing motor [3PN04208-1] MT8-L
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
148 Function
8.3 Function Details
Thermostat
Control
Freeze-up
Protection
Control
The thermostat turns OFF under the following temperature conditions to prevent freezing of the
indoor unit heat exchanger.
The motorized valve is controlled to maintain the indoor unit heat exchanger temperature
(Te) above 0C.
The outdoor unit fan speed is reduced to prevent freeze-up protection control from activating
during cooling operation under low outside air temperature. (For details, see the section on
cooling operation under low outside air temperature.)
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
Function 149
Condensation
Avoidance
Control (FHQ
Only)
Note: 1. Regardless of thermostat ON or OFF, the control can be functioned with the operation mode
of cooling (automatic cooling) or programmed drying.
2. The function is not provided for models other than FHQ models.
Outdoor Unit
Identification
Function
If the indoor unit is for both a heat pump and cooling only type, this function differentiates
whether the outdoor unit is functioning as a heat pump or cooling only unit, and automatically
decides the which operation modes can be set.
Operation modes which can be set
Heat pump : Fan / cool / dry / auto / heat
Drain Pump Control
After continuous 30 minutes of operation with downward
horizontal blade position, change the blade position to
level, and after one hour, the unit operation can be reset.
The unit operation can be reset with changing operation
mode into "heating" , changing air flow direction or turning
"ON" or "OFF" the unit operation.
(S1117)
Continuous 30 minutes operation of cooling One hour drying
Time A shown in below diagram
(Period from occurrence of drain water level abnormality to
compressor stop)
FHQ 10
Other than FHQ 0
1 Cooling and dry operation
1-1 Basic operation
A [sec]
Drain pump
ON
OFF
Compressor
ON
OFF
5min
For cooling or dry operation mode, drain pump is turned ON on compressor starting while turned OFF
when residual operation for 5 minutes is complete after compressor stopped.
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
150 Function
1-2 Operations when an occurrence of water level abnormality
1-2-a) Behavior between occurrence and recovery of water level abnormality
Occurrence of drain water level abnormality
5
sec
A 10
sec sec
1-2-b) Behavior when the unit restarts by remote controller after the water level abnormality is recovered
Intermittent operation (*1)
5min 5min
Compressor
ON
OFF
Drain pan
Water level abnormality
Normal
Drain pump
ON
OFF
Error processing
Abnormal
Normal
After compressor stops due to water level abnormality, drain pump is operated intermittently, i.e. 5 min
ON, 5 sec OFF and 5 min ON. (*1) The intermittent operation is executed regardless of recovery of water
level abnormality during the intermittent operation. (*2) When the water level abnormality can not be
recovered, the latter 5 min ON operation is continued until recovery of the abnormality. (*3)
*2
Even though the water level
abnormality could be recovered
during intermittent operation, the
operation shall be carried out
without exception.
*3
If the abnormality could not be recovered
during intermittent operation, the latter 5
min ON operation is continued until
recovery of the abnormality.
Water level abnormality shall be cancelled simultaneausly when the unit is turned off with remote controller
after recovery of the water level abnormality. When the unit is turned on with remote controller thereafter,
compressor starts operation 2 minutes later from the remote controller ON. (Below diagram shows an
example of the case that the water level abnormality is recovered during the former 5 min intermittent
operation.)
Occurrence of drain water level abnormality
5
sec
A 10
sec sec
Compressor starts operation after 2 minutes from
remote controller ON.
(When 3-min standby of compressor is complete.)
Alarm indication will be turned off with the remote controller
OFF operation after recovery of drain water level abnormality.
Recovery of drain water level abnormality
ON
2 min
Compressor
ON
OFF
Error processing
Abnormal
Normal
Remote controler
5min
Drain pan
Water level abnormality
Normal
Drain pump
ON
OFF
OFF
Note : (1 On the whole of cooling and dry operation)
Recovery operation for drain water level abnormality does not activate when the water level can
be returned normal within A + 10 seconds.
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
Function 151
2. Heating
2-1 Basic operation
2-1-1 When compressor stops during drain pump ON after compressor operation started
3
min
2-1-2 When compressor stops during drain pump OFF after compressor operation started
3
min
2-2 Operations when an occurrence of drain water level abnormality
2-2-a) Behavior between occurrence and recovery of drain water level abnormality
Drain pump
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Compressor
ON
OFF
5min 20 min
5min
Compressor
ON
OFF
20 min
20 min
Drain pump
In heating operation of the unit equipped with a humidifier, when "Interlocking of drain pump /
humidifier" (15(25)-3) is set to "yes" (02), the drain pump operates 20-min OFF and 3-min ON
repeatedly during compressor is in operation.
After compressor stops, residual operation will be conducted for 5 minutes.
2-2-a)-1 When a water level abnormality occurs during drain pump ON
Occurrence of drain water level abnormality
5
sec
A 10
sec sec
Compressor
ON
OFF
Error processing
5min
Abnormal
Normal
Drain pan
Water level abnormality
Normal
Drain pump
ON
OFF
5min
Intermittent operation (*1)
After compressor stops due to water level abnormality, drain pump is operated intermittenly, i.e. 5 min
ON, 5 sec OFF and 5 min ON. (*1) The intermittent operation is executed regardless of recovery of abn.
Water level during the intermittent operation. (*2) When the abn. water level can not be recovered, the
latter 5 min ON operation is continued until recovery of the abnormality. (*3) On above diagram, the
system operation in the event of a water level abnormality occurrence differs between the drain pump ON
and OFF. The details are as follows.
1 The same operation as 1-2-a) "Behavior between occurrence and recovery of drain water level
abnormality" in the mode of cooling or dry.
*2
Even though the water level
abnormality could be recovered
during intermittent operation, the
operation shall be carried out
without exception.
*3
If the abnormality could not be recovered
during intermittent operation, the latter 5
min ON operation is continued until
recovery of the abnormality.
Note : ((2-2-a)-1 When a water level abnormality occurs during drain pump ON)
Recovery operation for drain water level abnormality does not activate when the water level can
be returned normal within A + 10 seconds.
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
152 Function
2-2-a)-2 When a water level abnormality occurs during drain pump OFF
Occurrence of drain water level abnormality
5
sec
A
sec
80 sec
5min 5min
OFF
Drain pan
Water level abnormality
Normal
Error processing
Abnormal
Normal
Intermittent operation (*1)
Drain pump
ON
OFF
Compressor
ON
The abnormality is determined when 80 seconds elapse from compressor stop. Other than above,
behavior is same as 2-2-a).
Note : ((2-2-a)-2 When a water level abnormality occurs during drain pump OFF)
Recovery operation for drain water level abnormality does not activate when the water level can be
returned normal within A + 80 seconds.
2-2-b) Behavior when the unit restarts by remote controller after the water level abnormality is recovered
Occurrence of drain water level abnormality
5 3
sec min
A 10
sec sec
Compressor starts operation after 2 minutes from
remote controller ON.
(When 3-min standby of compressor is complete.)
Alarm indication will be turned off with the remote controller OFF
operation after recovery of drain water level abnormality.
Recovery of drain water level abnormality
5min 5min
Intermittent operation (*1)
Drain pan
Water level abnormality
Normal
Remote controler
ON
OFF
Drain pump
ON
OFF
Compressor
ON
OFF
Error processing
Abnormal
Normal
2 min
20 min 20min
Basic operation
Abnormal water level shall be cancelled simultaneausly when the unit is turned off with remote controller
after recovery of abnormal water level. When the unit is turned on with remote controller thereafter,
compressor starts operation 2 minutes later from the remote controller ON. (Below diagram shows an
example of the case that the water level abnormality is recovered during the former 5 min intermittent
operation after the abnormality occurred during drain pump ON.)
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
Function 153
Using Conditions
for Remote
Controller
Thermostat
Remote controller thermostat is equipped only in wired remote controller.
Even when use remote controller thermostat is selected in service mode, the remote controller
thermostat may not be used.
< Conditions not to use >
1. When the remote controller thermostat malfunctions.
2. When the one remote controller group control is applied.
(Excluding simultaneous ON/OFF operation)
3. When conditions relating set temperature with remote controller and suction air temperature
are out of the operating zone of remote controller thermostat shown in below diagram.
(Excluding when automatic operation mode is selected. Whenever operation is in the
automatic mode, remote controller thermostat can be used.)
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
154 Function
Program Dry
Operation
Function
The points of thermostat ON or OFF are determined according to the suction air temperature at
the startup of unit operation.
The set temperature and flow rate are not displayed on remote controller.
1. Thermostat ON point (TON) according to suction air temp. (TS).
2. Operation condition
Auto-restart
Function
If there is a power cut when the unit is operating, it will automatically resume the same operating
mode when the power is restored.
Caution When performing maintenance and the power supply is to be shut off, be sure to turn the remote
controllers ON/OFF switch OFF first.
Shutting the power supply switch off while the ON/OFF switch is still ON is dangerous because
the power failure automatic reset function will cause the indoor fan to start turning
immediately, or the outdoor unit fan to automatically start turning three minutes after the power
supply is turned back on.
Suction air temp TON(C) TdON (C)
Ts>24C
24C Ts>16C
16C Ts
Ts
Ts
16C
1.5
1.0
1.0
Compressor condition ON OFF
Setting of flow rate
Angle of flap
Air flow direction set with remote
controller
L operation
Set angle
Set angle
OFF
Set angle
Set angle
Operation startup
(Differential)
(S1120)
Thermostat
ON
Thermostat
OFF
S
u
c
t
i
o
n
a
i
r
t
e
m
p
.
T
s
Si18-525B Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models)
Function 155
Fan and Flap
Operations
1: L or LL operation for FFQ, FCQ only.
(L for 4way outlet and LL for 2way or 3way outlet)
Fan Flap Remote
Controller
Indication
FFQ, FCQ,
FHQ
Heating
Operation
Hot Start from Defrost In Swing
Operation
OFF Horizontal Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
OFF Horizontal Set Position
Defrost In Swing
Operation
OFF Horizontal Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
OFF Horizontal Set Position
Thermostat OFF In Swing
Operation
LL Horizontal Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
LL Horizontal Set Position
Hot Start from
Thermostat OFF
(Cold Air Prevention)
In Swing
Operation
LL Horizontal Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
LL Horizontal Set Position
Stop (Error) In Swing
Operation
OFF Horizontal
In Airflow
Direction Setting
OFF Horizontal
Overload Thermostat
OFF
In Swing
Operation
LL Horizontal Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
LL Horizontal Set Position
Cooling
Operation
Thermostat ON in
Program Dry Mode
In Swing
Operation
L Swing Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
L Setting Set Position
Thermostat OFF in
Program Dry Mode
In Swing
Operation
OFF Swing Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
OFF Setting Set Position
Cooling Thermostat
OFF
In Swing
Operation
Setting Swing Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
Setting Setting Set Position
Stop (Error) In Swing
Operation
OFF Horizontal
In Airflow
Direction Setting
OFF Setting
Freeze Prevention in
Program Dry Mode
(Including Cooling
Operation)
In Swing
Operation
L
1
Swing Swing
In Airflow
Direction Setting
L
1
Setting Set Position
Indoor Unit (SkyAir Models) Si18-525B
156 Function
Mode Conflict [Overview]
While the indoor unit for another room and the outdoor unit are operating, when the indoor unit
for the own room is activated, the operation mode which can be selected in the own room has
some restrictions as mentioned below.
i) In case an priority for operation mode selection is given to the own room by setting the dip
switch of outdoor unit;
The own room can be operated in any mode.
ii) In case an priority for operation mode selection is not given to the own room by setting the
dip switch of outdoor unit;
The unit can be operated as follows:
O: Operational :The unit for another room is switched into non-operational condition.
: Non-operational
* Operation of the indoor unit for the own room during non-operation.
Fan = OFF
Louver = becomes horizontal position.
ON LED on the remote controller = blinks.
Indication of "under central control" on the remote controller = displayed.
Note: During automatic operation, at the time of changing operation mode to Automatic cooling
or Automatic heating, the unit is operated as the table shown above.
Outdoor unit
operation mode
when an operation
mode for the own
room is selected.
(The outdoor unit
is operated in the
mode as
mentioned below.)
Operation mode selected in the own room
Cooling or
Automatic cooling
(Note)
Dry Blowing
Heating or
Automatic heating
(Note)
Cooling O O O
Heating O
Blowing O O O O
(Q0518)
Press and hold the TEST
OPERATION button (BS4) on
outdoor unit PCB for 5
seconds.
The test operation is started automatically.
The following judgements are conducted within 15 minutes(about 30
minutes at the maximum).
2Check for wrong wiring
2Check stop valve for not open
The following indications are conducted while in test operation.
2LED lamp on outdoor unit PC board H2P Blinks (test operation)
2Remote controller Indicates (during centralized control) on
upper right.
Indicates (test operation) on lower left
(Only for SkyAir)
Malfunction
code
Nonconformity during installation Remedial action
E3
The stop valves in the outdoor unit remain
closed.
Open the stop valve on both the gas side and liquid side.
E4
F3
The stop valves in the outdoor unit remain
closed.
Open the stop valve on both the gas side and liquid side.
The operation mode on the remote controller
was changed before the check run.
Set the operating mode on all indoor unit remote controllers to
cooling.
The refrigerant is insufficient. Check whether additional refrigerant charge has been finished
correctly.
Calculate again the required quantity of refrigerant to be
charged based on the piping length, then charge additionally
proper quantity of refrigerant.
U3 The check operation is not performed. Perform the check operation.
U4 The power is not supplied to the outdoor unit. Connect correctly the power cable of the outdoor unit.
UA
Improper type of indoor units or BP units are
connected.
Check the type of indoor units and BP units currently connected.
If they are not proper, replace them with proper ones.
UF
The stop valves in the outdoor unit remain
closed.
Open the stop valve on both the gas side and liquid side.
The piping and wiring of the specified indoor
unit are not connected correctly to the
outdoor unit.
Confirm that the piping and wiring of the specified indoor unit are
connected correctly to the outdoor unit.
The operation mode on the remote
controller was changed before the check
operation.
Set the operating mode on all indoor unit remote controllers to
cooling.
UH
The unit-to-unit wirings are not connected
correctly.
Connect correctly the unit-to-unit wirings to the F1 and F2(TO BP
UNIT) terminals on the PC board (A1P) in the outdoor unit.
Test Operation Si18-525B
164 Test Operation
1.1.8 Confirmation on Normal Operation
Conduct normal unit operation after the check operation has been completed.
(When outdoor air temperature is 30CDB or higher, the unit can not be operated with
heating mode. See the installation manual attached.)
Confirm that the indoor/outdoor units can be operated normally.
(When an abnormal noise due to liquid compression by the compressor can be heard, stop
the unit immediately, and turn on the crankcase heater to heat up it sufficiently, then start
operation again.)
Operate indoor unit one by one to check that the outdoor unit operates.
Confirm that the indoor unit discharges cold air (or warm air).
Operate the air direction control button and flow rate control button to check the function of
the devices.
Si18-525B Outdoor Unit PCB Layout
Test Operation 165
2. Outdoor Unit PCB Layout
Outdoor Unit PCB
BS1
MODE SET RETURN TEST RESET
BS2 BS3 BS4 BS5
H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
A B C
C/H SELECTOR TO BP UNIT
(2) Set mode display (LED)
(3) Mode setting switch
(1) Microcomputer normal monitor
(4)Local setting switch
Connection terminal for transmission use
DS1 DS2
HAP
(Q0404)
(1) Microcomputer normal monitor (LED Green)
This monitor blinks while in normal operation, and turns on or off when a malfunction occurs.
(2) Set mode display (LED Orange)
LEDs display mode according to the setting.
(3) Mode setting switch
Used to change mode.
(4) Local setting switch
Used to make local settings.
F1 F2 F1 F2
Field Setting Si18-525B
166 Test Operation
3. Field Setting
3.1 Field Setting from Outdoor Unit
3.1.1 Setting by dip switches
The following field settings are made by dip switches on PCB.
Dipswitch
Setting item Description
No. Setting
DS1-1
ON Cool / Heat
change over
setting
Used to set cool / heat change over setting by
remote controller equipped with outdoor unit. OFF (Factory set)
DS1-2
~DS1-4
ON
Not used Do not change the factory settings.
OFF (Factory set)
DS2-1
~4
ON
Not used Do not change the factory settings.
OFF (Factory set)
Caution DIP switch Setting after changing the main PCB (A1P) to spare parts PCB.
When you change the main PCB (A1P) to spare parts PCB, please carry out the following
setting.
The spare parts PCB is different from the PCB on factory shipment above in a way of setting.
When you exchange to the spare parts PCB, make sure that you change setting referring the
following table.
DIP Switch Detail
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
DS1 DS2
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
DS No.
DS1-1
Item Contents
Not used Do not change the factory setting
The following setting is performed according to capability of the outdoor unit.
Cool/Heat change
over setting
The Cool/Heat change over setting is carried out by COOL/HEAT
changeover remote controller fitted to outdoor unit.
The Cool/Heat change over setting is not carried out by
COOL/HEAT changeover remote controller fitted to outdoor unit.
Cooling only
Heat-pump
DS1-2
Cooling only/Heat-
pump setting
ON
ON
OFF
Connect BP unit
Not connect BP unit
DS1-3 BP Unit
ON
OFF
OFF
DS1-4
DS2-1
HP setting
(Horse power)
DS2-1
DS2-2
DS2-2
DS2-3
DS2-4
ON
OFF
OFF
ON
OFF
OFF
4HP 5HP 6HP
OFF OFF
OFF
ON DS2-3
OFF OFF DS2-4
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 167
Setting by pushbutton switches
The following settings are made by pushbutton switches on PCB.
(Factory setting)
There are the following three setting modes.
C Setting mode 1 (H1P off)
Initial status (when normal) : Also indicates during abnormal.
C Setting mode 2 (H1P on)
Used to modify the operating status and to set program addresses, etc. Usually used in
servicing the system.
C Monitor mode (H1P blinks)
Used to check the program made in Setting mode 2.
Mode changing procedure
Mode changing procedure
H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
LED indication 7 7 8 7 7 7 7
BS1
MODE
BS2
SET
BS3
RETURN
BS4
TEST
BS5
RESET
(V2760)
Setting mode 1 Monitor mode
H1P
Push the BS1(MODE button)
one time.
Blinking
MODE MODE
Off
H1P
Setting mode 2
MODE
On
H1P
Push and hold the BS1
(MODE button) for 5 seconds.
Push the BS1(MODE button) one time.
(Normal)
(V2761)
Using the MODE button, the modes can be changed as follows.
Check item selection (Set)
Contents display
Monitor mode
Setting mode 1
(Initial condition)
Press BS3
(RETURN button).
Press BS3
(RETURN button).
Setting item selection (Set)
Setting mode 2
(Set): Select mode with BS2 (SET button) in each selection step.
Setting condition
selection (Set)
Setting condition
(Contents) display
Press BS3
(RETURN button).
Press BS3
(RETURN button).
Press BS3
(RETURN button). Press BS1
(MODE button).
Press BS1
(MODE button).
Press BS1(MODE button). Press BS1 (MODE button) for more than 5 sec.
(V2762)
Field Setting Si18-525B
168 Test Operation
Display for malfunction/preparing/test-run
Setting (displaying) item
LED display example
H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
Normal
7 7 8 7 7 7 7
Malfunction
7 8 8 7 7 7 7
Preparing/Test-run
7 9 8 7 7 7 7
8 : ON
7 : OFF
9 : Blinking
a. Setting mode 1
Normally, Setting mode 1 is set.
In case of other status, push MODE
button (BS1) one time and set to
Setting mode 1.
The current state is displayed.
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 169
No. Setting item Description
5
Indoor unit forced
fan H
Allows forced operation of indoor unit fan while unit is
stopped. (H tap)
6
Indoor unit forced
operation
Allows forced operation of indoor unit.
8 Te setting Target evaporation temperature for cooling
9 Tc setting Target condensation temperature for heating
10
Defrost changeover
setting
Changes the temperature condition for defrost and sets to
quick defrost or slow defrost.
21
Refrigerant
collection mode
setting
Sets to refrigerant collection mode.
22
Night quiet mode
setting
Sets automatic Night quiet operation in a simple way.
The operating time is based on Starting set and Ending
set.
26
Night quiet mode
control starting
setting
Sets starting time of Night quiet operation. (Night quiet
mode setting is also required.)
27
Night quiet mode
control ending
setting
Sets ending time of Night quiet operation. (Night quiet
mode setting is also required.)
29
Capacity
precedence setting
If the capacity control is required, the low noise control is
automatically released by this setting during carrying out
low noise operation and Night quiet operation.
30 Demand setting 1
Changes target value of power consumption when
demand control 1 is input.
31 Demand setting 2
Changes target value of power consumption when
demand control 2 is input.
32
Normal demand
setting
Normally enables demand control 1 without external
input. (Effective to prevent a problem that circuit breaker
of small capacity is shut down due to large load.
b. Setting mode 2
<Selection of setting items>
<Selection of setting conditions>
Push and hold the MODE button
(BS1) for 5 seconds and set to
Setting mode 2.
Push the SET button (BS2) and set
the LED display to a setting item
shown in the table on the right.
Push the RETURN button (BS3) and
decide the item. (The present setting
condition is blinked.)
Push the SET button (BS2) and set
to the setting condition you want.
Push the RETURN button (BS3) and
decide the condition.
Push the RETURN button (BS3) and
set to the initial status of Setting
mode 2.
If you become unsure of how to
proceed, push the MODE button
(BS1) and return to setting mode 1.
(V2764)
Field Setting Si18-525B
170 Test Operation
No.
Setting item display
Setting condition display
Setting item
MODE
H1P
TEST
H2P
C/H selection Low
noise
H6P
Demand
H7P
IND
H3P
Master
H4P
Slave
H5P
Factory set
5 Indoor forced fan H 8 7 7 7 8 7 8
Normal operation
8777778
Indoor forced fan H
8777787
6
Indoor forced
operation
8 7 7 7 8 8 7
Normal operation
8777778
Indoor forced operation
8777787
8 Te setting 8 7 7 8 7 7 7
High (H)
8777877
Normal (M)
8777787
Low (L)
8777778
9 Tc setting 8 7 7 8 7 7 8
High (H)
8777877
Normal (M)
8777787
Low (L)
8777778
10 Defrost setting 8 7 7 8 7 8 7
Quick defrost
8777877
Normal
8777787
Slow defrost
8777778
21
Refrigerant recovery
mode setting
8 7 8 7 8 7 8
Refrigerant recovery: OFF
8777778
Refrigerant recovery: ON
8777787
22
Night quiet mode
setting
8 7 8 7 8 8 7
OFF
8777777
Level 1
8777778
Level 2
8777787
Level 3
8777788
26
Night quiet mode
control start setting
8 7 8 8 7 8 7
About 20:00
8777778
About 22:00
8777787
About 24:00
8777877
27
Night quiet mode
control end setting
8 7 8 8 7 8 8
About 6:00
8777778
About 7:00
8777787
About 8:00
8777877
29
Capacity
precedence setting
8 7 8 8 8 7 8
OFF
8777778
ON
8777787
30 Demand setting 1 8 7 8 8 8 8 7
60% demand
8777778
70% demand
8777787
80% demand
8777877
31 Demand setting 2 8 7 8 8 8 8 8
30% demand
8777778
40% demand
8777787
50% demand
8777877
32
Continuous demand
setting
8 8 7 7 7 7 7
OFF
8777778
ON
8777787
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 171
Setting item 0 Display contents of Various settings
No. Setting item
LED display
Data display
H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
0 Various settings 9 7 7 7 7 7 7 See below
5 Number of connected indoor units 9 7 7 7 8 7 8 Lower 6 digits
14
Contents of malfunction (the
latest)
9 7 7 8 8 8 7
Malfunction
code table
15
Contents of malfunction
(1 cycle before)
9 7 7 8 8 8 8
16
Contents of malfunction
(2 cycle before)
9 7 8 7 7 7 7
20 Contents of retry (the latest) 9 7 8 7 8 7 7
21 Contents of retry (1 cycle before) 9 7 8 7 8 7 8
22 Contents of retry (2 cycle before) 9 7 8 7 8 8 7
Setting item H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
Defrost select setting Short
9 7 7 7 8 7 7
Medium
9 7 7 7 9 7 7
Long
9 7 7 7 7 7 7
Te setting H
9 7 7 7 7 8 7
M
9 7 7 7 7 9 7
L
9 7 7 7 7 7 7
Tc setting H
9 7 7 7 7 7 8
M
9 7 7 7 7 7 9
L
9 7 7 7 7 7 7
c. Monitor mode
<Selection of setting item>
<Confirmation on setting contents>
To enter the monitor mode, push the
MODE button (BS1) when in
Setting mode 1.
Push the SET button (BS2) and set
the LED display to a setting item.
Push the RETURN button (BS3) to
display different data of set items.
Push the RETURN button (BS3) and
switches to the initial status of
Monitor mode.
Push the MODE button (BS1) and
returns to Setting mode 1.
(V2765)
Push the SET button and match with the LEDs No. 1 - 15, push the RETURN button, and
enter the data for each setting.
Data such as addresses and number of units is expressed as binary numbers; the two
ways of expressing are as follows:
The No. 5 cool/heat unified address is expressed as a binary
number consisting of the lower 6 digits. (0 - 63)
In C the address is 000110 (binary number), which translates to
4 + 2 = 6 (base 10 number). In other words, the address is 6.
9 797997
16 4 1
32 8 2
Field Setting Si18-525B
172 Test Operation
3.2 Detail of Setting Mode
3.2.1 Cool / Heat Mode Switching
There are the following 2 cool/heat switching modes.
C Set cool/heat separately for each outdoor unit system by indoor unit remote controller.
C Set cool/heat separately for each outdoor unit system by cool/heat switching remote
controller.
C Set Cool/Heat Separately for Each Outdoor System by Indoor Unit Remote Controller
4 Set outdoor unit PCB DS1-1 to indoor (factory set).
4 Set cool/heat switching to individual for Setting mode 1 (factory set).
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 173
C Set Cool / Heat Separately for Each Outdoor Unit System by Cool/Heat Switching Remote Controller
4 Set outdoor unit PCB DS1-1 to outdoor (factory set).
4 Set cool/heat switching to individual for Setting mode 1 (factory set).
Field Setting Si18-525B
174 Test Operation
3.2.2 Setting of Low Noise Operation and Demand Operation
Setting of Low Noise Operation
By connecting the external contact input to the low noise input of the outdoor unit external
control adaptor (optional), you can lower operating noise by 2-3 dB.
A. When the low noise operation is carried out by external instructions (with the use
of the outdoor unit external control adaptor)
1. Set External low noise / Demand YES/NO setting to External low noise / Demand YES.
(Set by Setting Mode 2)
2. Set External low noise level setting on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(Lower noise operation can be carried out by Mode 2 than by Mode 1, and by Mode 3
than by Mode 2.)
3. Set Capacity precedence setting on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(If set to ON, when air conditioning load gets higher, the low noise instructions are
neglected to switch to normal operation.) (Set by Setting Mode 2)
B. When the low noise operation is carried out automatically at night (The outdoor unit
external control adaptor is not required)
1. Set Night quiet mode setting on the outdoor unit PCB. (Set by Setting Mode 2)
(Lower noise operation can be carried out by Mode 2 than by Mode 1, and by Mode 3
than by Mode 2.)
2. Set Night quiet mode start setting on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises. (Set by
Setting Mode 2)
(Since the time is presumed in accordance with the outdoor temperature, the starting time is
a target only.)
3. Set Night quiet mode end setting on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(Set by Setting Mode 2)
(Since the time is presumed in accordance with the outdoor temperature, the ending time is
a target only.)
4. Set Capacity precedence setting on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(Set by Setting Mode 2)
(If set to ON, when air conditioning load gets higher, the status is switched to normal
operation even at night.)
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 175
Image of operation in the case of A
Image of operation in the case of B
Image of operation in the case of A and B
Field Setting Si18-525B
176 Test Operation
Setting of Demand Operation
By connecting the external contact input to the demand input of the outdoor unit external control
adaptor (optional), the power consumption of unit operation can be saved suppressing the
compressor operating condition.
A. When the demand operation is carried out by external instructions (with the use of the
outdoor unit external control adaptor).
Set the "External low noise / Demand YES / NO setting" switch on the outdoor unit PCB to
the "External low noise / Demand YES".
(Set by Setting Mode 2)
Set the "Demand 1 level setting" on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(During the demand level 1 instruction, the power consumption can be saved to 80%, 70%
or 60% of the rated value respectively.)
B. When the continuous demand operation is carried out. (Use of the outdoor unit
external control adaptor is not required.)
Set the "Continuous demand setting" on the outdoor unit PCB.
If the "Continuous demand setting" is set to the "Continuous demand 1 fixing", set the
"Demand 1 setting" on the outdoor unit PCB, as the need arises.
(During the continuous demand level 1 operation, the power consumption can be saved to
80%, 70% or 60% of the rated value respectively.)
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 177
Image of operation in the case of A
Image of operation in the case of B
Image of operation in the case of A and B
(V3081)
Power consumption
Rated power consumption
80 % of rated power consumption
70 % of rated power consumption
60 % of rated power consumption
40 % of rated power consumption
Forced thermostat OFF
(Fan operation)
Demand level 1 instructing
Power consumption set by
"Demand 1 level setting".
Demand level 2 instructing Demand level 3 instructing
The power
consumption during
the demand level 1
instructing can be
set with the
"Demand 1 level
setting".
("70 % of rated
power consumption"
has been set at
factory.)
(V3082)
The power consumption set with "Demand 1 level setting".
When the
"Continuous demand
setting" is set to ON
("OFF" has been set
at factory.) , the
power consumption
can be set with the
"Demand 1 level
setting". ("70 % of
rated power
consumption" has
been set at factory.)
Power consumption
Rated power consumption
80 % of rated power consumption
70 % of rated power consumption
60 % of rated power consumption
40 % of rated power consumption
Forced thermostat OFF
(Fan operation)
(V3083)
The power consumption set with "Demand 1 level setting".
Demand level 2 instructing Demand level 3 instructing
The power
consumption can be
set with the
"Demand 1 level
setting". ("70 % of
rated power
consumption" has
been set at factory.)
During continuous demand operation,
when the external demand instruction is
received repeatedly, the instruction with
higher demand level has the precedence.
Power consumption
Rated power consumption
80 % of rated power consumption
70 % of rated power consumption
60 % of rated power consumption
40 % of rated power consumption
Forced thermostat OFF
(Fan operation)
Field Setting Si18-525B
178 Test Operation
Detailed Setting Procedure of Low Noise Operation and Demand Control
1. Setting mode 1 (H1P off)
C In setting mode 2, push the BS1 (MODE button) one time. Setting mode 2 is entered and
H1P lights.
During the setting mode 1 is displayed, In low noise operation and In demand control are
displayed.
2. Setting mode 2 (H1P on)
C In setting 1, push and hold the BS1 (MODE button) for more than 5 seconds. Setting
mode 2 is entered and H1P lights.
C Push the BS2 (SET button) several times and match the LED display with the Setting No.
you want.
C Push the BS3 (RETURN button) one time, and the present setting content is displayed.
Push the BS2 (SET button) several times and match the LED display with the setting
content (as shown below) you want.
C Push the BS3 (RETURN button) two times. Returns to C.
C Push the BS1 (MODE button) one time. Returns to the setting mode 1 and turns H1P off.
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 179
C C C
Settin
g No.
Setting
contents
Setting No. indication Setting No. indication Setting
contents
Setting contents indication (Initial setting)
H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P H1P H2P H3P H4P H5P H6P H7P
22 Night quiet
mode
setting
O O O O O
OFF
(Factory
setting)
O
Mode 1
O O
Mode 2
O O
Mode 3
O O O
25 External
low noise
setting
O O O O
Mode 1
O O
Mode 2
(Factory
setting)
O O
Mode 3
O O
26 Night quiet
mode start
setting
O O O O
PM 8:00
O O
PM 10:00
(Factory
setting)
O O
PM 0:00
O O
27 Night quiet
mode end
setting
O O O O O
AM 6:00
O O
AM 7:00
O O
AM 8:00
(Factory
setting)
O O
29 Capacity
precedence
setting
O O O O O
Low noise
precedence
(Factory
setting)
O O
Capacity
precedence
O O
30 Demand
setting 1
O O O O O
60% of
rated power
consumptio
n
O O
70% of
rated power
consumptio
n (Factory
setting)
O O
80% of
rated power
consumptio
n
O O
31 Demand
setting 2
O O O O O O
30% of
rated power
consumptio
n
O O
40% of
rated power
consumptio
n (Factory
setting)
O O
50% of
rated power
consumptio
n
O O
32 Continuous
demand
setting
O
OFF
(Factory
setting)
O O
Continuous
demand 1
fixed
O O
12 External
low noise /
Demand
setting
O O O
NO
(Factory
set)
O O
YES
O O
Setting mode indication section Setting No. indication section Set contents indication section
Field Setting Si18-525B
180 Test Operation
3.2.3 Setting of Refrigerant Recovery Mode
When carrying out the refrigerant collection on site, fully open the respective expansion valve of
BP and outdoor unit.
Both the outdoor unit and the indoor unit are forbidden to operation.
Operation
Procedure
C In setting mode 2 with units in stop mode, set B Refrigerant Recovery / Vacuuming mode
to ON. The respective expansion valve of BP and outdoor units are fully opened. (H2P turns
to display (test operation) (blinks), (test operation) and (during contralized
control) are displayed on the remote controller (only for SkyAir), and the operation is
prohibited.
C Collect the refrigerant using a refrigerant recovery unit. (See the instruction attached to the
refrigerant recovery unit for more detal.)
C Press Mode button BS1 once and reset Setting Mode 2.
3.2.4 Setting of Vacuuming Mode
In order to perform vacuuming operation at site, fully open the expansion valves of BP and
outdoor units to turn on some solenoid valves.
Both the outdoor unit and the indoor unit are forbidden to operation.
Operating
procedure
C With Setting Mode 2 while the unit stops, set (B) Refrigerant recovery / Vacuuming mode to
ON. The expansion valves of BP and outdoor units fully open and some of solenoid valves
open.
(H2P blinks to indicate the test operation, and the remote controller displays (test
operation) and (during contralized control) (only for SkyAir), thus prohibiting operation.)
After setting, do not cancel Setting Mode 2 until completion of Vacuuming operation.
C Use the vacuum pump to perform vacuuming operation.
C Press Mode button BS1 once and reset Setting Mode 2.
Si18-525B Field Setting
Test Operation 181
3.2.5 Check Operation
To prevent any trouble in the period of installation at site, the system is provided with a test
operation mode enabling check for incorrect wiring, stop valve left in closed, and judgment of
piping length.
Unit stopping
Press the TEST button for 5 seconds.
10 sec to 10 minutes
LED display (H1P~H7P) (8:ON 9:BLINKING 3:OFF)
3383333
3933338
Pressure equalizing Step 1
30 sec to 200 sec
10 minutes
To 30 seconds
3933383
Cooling start control Step 2
3933388
3933888
3938333
3383333
Stability waiting operation Step 3
Pump down residual operation Step 7
5 minutes
Standby for restarting
Completion
Step 8
Stop valve close check
Wrong wiring check
3 minutes
3933833
3933838
3933883
Judgement function
Step4~6
CHECK OPERATION FUNCTION
(Q0383)
Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit Si18-525B
182 Test Operation
4. Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit
4.1 Explanation
Field set is carried out from the remote controller. At time of installation, or after maintenance
inspection/repair, carry out field set according to the explanation below. Incorrect settings will
cause a malfunction to occur. (The indoor unit settings are sometimes changed if optional
accessories are mounted on the indoor unit. Refer to the optional accessory manual.)
Si18-525B Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit
Test Operation 183
4.2 Field Setting
4.2.1 Wired Remote Controller
Note: (Field setting must be made from the remote controller in accordance with the installation
conditions.)
Setting can be made by changing the Mode number, FIRST CODE NO., and SECOND
CODE NO..
Refer to the following procedures for Field setting.
Procedure
Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit Si18-525B
184 Test Operation
4.2.2 Wireless Remote Controller
Note: If optional accessories are mounted on the indoor unit, the indoor unit setting may have to be
changed. Refer to the instruction manual (optional hand book) for each optional accessory.
Procedure 1. When in the normal mode, push the button for a minimum of four seconds,
and the FIELD SET MODE is entered.
2. Select the desired MODE NO. with the button.
3. Push the button and select the FIRST CODE NO.
4. Push the button and select the SECOND CODE NO.
5. Push the button and the present settings are SET.
6. Push the button to return to the NORMAL MODE.
4.3 Initial Setting Contents
Setting Contents
Indoor Models
Filter
Sign
Filter Sign
Estimation of
Accumulated
Operating
Hours
High Air
Outlet
Velocity
(for
Application
to Ceiling
Higher
than 2.7m)
Selection
of Air
Flow
Direction
F (4 way),
T (3 way),
W (2 way)
Air Flow
Direction
Adjust
Air Flow
Direction
Range
Setting
Long
Life
Filter
Type
Ceiling Mounted
Cassette type
600600 (FFQ)
O O O O O O
Ceiling Mounted
Cassette type
950950 (FCQ)
O O O O O
Ceiling Mounted
Built-in type (FBQ)
O O
Ceiling Suspended
type (FHQ)
O O O
Si18-525B Field Setting for SkyAir Indoor Unit
Test Operation 185
4.4 Local Setting Mode Number
Example To set the filter sign time to filter contamination - heavy for all units in a group:
Set mode No. to 10, setting switch No. to 0, and setting position No. to 02.
Table
Note: 1. Setting is made in all units in a group. To set for individual indoor units or to check the
setting, use the mode Nos. (with 2 in upper digit) in parentheses ( ).
2. The setting position No. is set to 01 at the factory, except for the following cases in which
02 is set.
Setting of air flow direction adjustment range 13(23)-4
Automatic restart after power outage. 12(22)-5
Remote control thermostat 10(20)-2
Filter sign indication (only for ceiling-mounted duct type) 10(20)-3
3. Since drafts may result, carefully select the installation location.
4. When power returns, units resume the settings made before the power failure.
Caution When auto restart after power failure reset is set, be sure to turn off air conditioners, then cut
off the power supply before conducting maintenance, inspection and other work. If the power
supply is cut off with the power switch left ON, air conditioners will automatically start operating
when the power supply is turned on.
5. Do not set any items other than those listed in the above table.
6. Functions that indoor units are not equipped with will not be displayed.
7. When returning to normal mode, 88 may be displayed on the LCD section of the remote
controller due to initialization operation.
Mode
No.
Note 1
Setting
Switch
No.
Setting Description Setting Position No. *Note 2
01 02 03
10
(20)
0 Filter contamination - heavy /
light (Setting of operating
hours for filter sign indication)
(Change setting when
reducing filter sign indication
time to half due to quick soiling
of filter)
Long-Life
Type
Light Approx.
2,500
hours
Heavy Approx.
1,250
hours
3PN00286-13U
Instruction Si18-525B
198 Operation Manual
2.2 Wall Mounted, Duct, Floor/Ceiling, Floor Standing,
Wall Built-in Type
2.2.1 Manual Contents and Reference Page
: Illustrations are for wall mounted type FTKD50-71F as representative.
Model Series
Wall Mounted Type
FTK(X)S20-35D
FTKD25/35D
FTK(X)S50~71B FTKD50-71F FTK50-71A
Read before Operation
Safety Precautions 199 199 199 199
Names of Parts 201 204 207 210
Preparation before Operation 222 222 222 222
Operation
AUTO, DRY, COOL, HEAT, FAN
Operation
225 225 225 225
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction 227 229 231 233
POWERFUL Operation 239 239 239 239
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET Operation 240 240 240 240
ECONO Operation 241
MOLD PROOF Operation 242
HOME LEAVE Operation 243 243 243
INTELLIGENT EYE Operation 245 247 249
TIMER Operation 251 251 251 251
Note for Multi System 253 253 253 253
Care
Care and Cleaning 255 258 261 264
Trouble Shooting
Troubleshooting 275 275 275 275
Drawing No. 3P194550-4
3P194550-5
3P194539-2
3P142638-1L
C : 3P098595-11P
C : 3P098586-1J
3P192025-2
3P077961-12K
3P077963-2G
Model Series
Duct Connected Type
Floor/Ceiling
Suspended Dual Type
Floor Standing Type
FDKS25/35C
CDK(X)S25~60C
CDKD25~60C
CDKD25/35E FLXS25-60B FVXS35/50B
Read before Operation
Safety Precautions 199 199 199 199
Names of Parts 213 213 216 219
Preparation before Operation 222 222 222 222
Operation
AUTO, DRY, COOL, HEAT, FAN
Operation
225 225 225 225
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction 235 237
POWERFUL Operation 239 239 239 239
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET Operation 240 240 240 240
ECONO Operation
MOLD PROOF Operation
HOME LEAVE Operation 243 243 243 243
INTELLIGENT EYE Operation
TIMER Operation 251 251 251 251
Note for Multi System 253 253 253 253
Care
Care and Cleaning 267 268 269 272
Trouble Shooting
Trouble Shooting 275 275 275 275
Drawing No. 3P141308-5G
3P196326-5
3P196326-2
3P196326-4 3P194537-7 C : 3P141308-2F
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 199
2.2.2 Safety Precautions
Safety precautions
Keep this manual where the operator can easily find them.
Read this manual attentively before starting up the unit.
For safety reason the operator must read the following cautions carefully.
This manual classifies precautions into WARNINGS and CAUTIONS. Be sure to follow all precau-
tions below: they are all important for ensuring safety.
WARNING
In order to avoid fire, explosion or injury, do not operate the unit when harmful, among which flammable or
corrosive gases, are detected near the unit.
It is not good for health to expose your body to the air flow for a long time.
Do not put a finger, a rod or other objects into the air outlet or inlet. As the fan is rotating at a high speed, it will
cause injury.
Do not attempt to repair, relocate, modify or reinstall the air conditioner by yourself. Incorrect work will cause electric
shocks, fire etc.
For repairs and reinstallation, consult your Daikin dealer for advice and information.
The refrigerant used in the air conditioner is safe. Although leaks should not occur, if for some
reason any refrigerant happens to leak into the room, make sure it does not come in contact
with any flame as of gas heaters, kerosene heaters or gas range.
If the air conditioner is not cooling (heating) properly, the refrigerant may be leaking, so call your dealer.
When carrying out repairs accompanying adding refrigerant, check the content of the repairs with our service staff.
Do not attempt to install the air conditioner by your self. Incorrect work will result in water leakage, electric shocks or
fire. For installation, consult the dealer or a qualified technician.
In order to avoid electric shock, fire or injury, if you detect any abnormally such as smell of fire, stop the operation and
turn off the breaker. And call your dealer for instructions.
CAUTION
The air conditioner must be earthed. Incomplete earthing may result in electric shocks. Do not connect the
earth line to a gas pipe, water pipe, lightning rod, or a telephone earth line.
In order to avoid any quality deterioration, do not use the unit for cooling precision instruments, food, plants,
animals or works of art.
Never expose little children, plants or animals directly to the air flow.
Do not place appliances which produce open fire in places exposed to the air flow from the unit or under the
indoor unit. It may cause incomplete combustion or deformation of the unit due to the heat.
Do not block air inlets nor outlets. Impaired air flow may result in insufficient performance or trouble.
WARNING
If you do not follow these instructions exactly, the unit may
cause property damage, personal injury or loss of life.
CAUTION
If you do not follow these instructions exactly, the unit may
cause minor or moderate property damage or personal injury.
Never do. Be sure to follow the instructions.
Be sure to earth the air conditioner.
Never cause the air conditioner (including the remote
controller) to get wet.
Never touch the air conditioner (including the remote
controller) with a wet hand.
Instruction Si18-525B
200 Operation Manual
Do not stand or sit on the outdoor unit. Do not place any object on the unit to avoid injury, do not remove the fan guard.
Do not place anything under the indoor or outdoor unit that must be kept away from moisture. In certain conditions,
moisture in the air may condense and drip.
After a long use, check the unit stand and fittings for damage.
Do not touch the air inlet and aluminum fins of outdoor unit. It may cause injury.
The appliance is not intended for use by young children or infirm persons without supervision.
Young children shuld be supervised to ensure that they do not play with the appliance.
To avoid oxygen deficiency, ventilate the room sufficiently if equipment with burner is used together with the
air conditioner.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation, turn the breaker off or pull out the supply cord.
Do not connect the air conditioner to a power supply different from the one as specified. It may cause trou-
ble or fire.
Depending on the environment, an earth leakage breaker must be installed. Lack of an earth leakage breaker may
result in electric shocks.
Arrange the drain hose to ensure smooth drainage. Incomplete draining may cause wetting of the building, furniture
etc.
Do not place objects in direct proximity of the outdoor unit and do not let leaves and other debris accumulate around
the unit.
Leaves are a hotbed for small animals which can enter the unit. Once in the unit, such animals can cause malfunc-
tions, smoke or fire when making contact with electrical parts.
Do not operate the air conditioner with wet hands.
Do not wash the indoor unit with excessive water, only use a slightly wet cloth.
Do not place things such as vessels containing water or anything else on top of the unit. Water may pene-
trate into the unit and degrade electrical insulations, resulting in an electric shock.
To install the air conditioner in the following types of environments, consult the dealer.
Places with an oily ambient or where steam or soot occurs.
Salty environment such as coastal areas.
Places where sulfide gas occurs such as hot springs.
Places where snow may block the outdoor unit.
The drain from the outdoor unit must be discharged to a place of good drainage.
For installation, choose a place as described below.
A place solid enough to bear the weight of the unit which does not amplify the operation noise or vibration.
A place from where the air discharged from the outdoor unit or the operation noise will not annoy
your neighbours.
For power supply, be sure to use a separate power circuit dedicated to the air conditioner.
Relocating the air conditioner requires specialized knowledge and skills. Please consult the dealer if reloca-
tion is necessary for moving or remodeling.
Installation site
Consider nuisance to your neighbours from noises
Electrical work
System relocation
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 201
2.2.3 Names of Parts
FTK(X)S 20/25/35 D, FTKD 25/35 D
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
ON/OFF
16 14
13
15
12
1 3 4
5
7
9 10 11
8
6
2
Instruction Si18-525B
202 Operation Manual
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Air filter
2. Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter:
These filters are attached to the inside of the air
filters.
3. Air inlet
4. Front panel
5. Panel tab
6. Room temperature sensor:
It senses the air temperature around the unit.
7. INTELLIGENT EYE sensor:
It detects the movements of people and auto-
matically switches between normal operation
and energy saving operation.
8. Display
9. Air outlet
10. Flaps (horizontal blades)
11. louvers (vertical blades):
The louvers are inside of the air outlet.
12. Indoor Unit ON/OFF switch:
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
The operation mode refers to the following
table.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
13. Operation lamp (green)
14. TIMER lamp (yellow)
15. INTELLIGENT EYE lamp (green)
16. Signal receiver:
It receives signals from the remote controller.
When the unit receives a signal, you will hear a
short beep.
Operation start .............beep-beep
Settings changed..........beep
Operation stop ..............beeeeep
Outdoor Unit
17. Air inlet: (Back and side)
18. Air outlet
19. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
20. Drain hose
21. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
22. Outside air temperature sensor:
It senses the ambient temperature around the
unit.
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
19
22
20
21
18
17
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow
rate
FTK COOL 22C AUTO
FTX AUTO 25C AUTO
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 203
Remote Controller
1. Signal transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown
with all its displays ON for the purpose of
explanation.)
3. ECONO button:
ECONO operation
4. POWERFUL button:
POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(AUTO/DRY/COOL/HEAT/FAN)
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. SWING button
11. MOLD PROOF button:
MOLD PROOF operation
12. SENSOR button: INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
13. ON TIMER button
14. OFF TIMER button
15. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
16. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
17. CLOCK button
18. RESET button:
Restart the unit if it freezes.
Use a thin object to push.
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
MODE FAN SWING
SENSOR
ECONO
MOLD PROOF
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1
2
5
6
9
10
12
11
16
18
17
13
15
14
<ARC433B46, B47>
3
4
7
8
8. QUIET button: OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET
operation
Instruction Si18-525B
204 Operation Manual
FTK(X)S 50/60/71 B
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
Main unit control panel
7
14
11
12
13
4
3
15
1
2
9
10
8
6
5
The illustration shows a 50-class unit
17
16
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 205
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Air filter
2. Air purifying filter with photocatalytie
deodorizing function:
These filters are attached to the inside of the air
filters.
3. Air inlet
4. Front grille
5. Grille tab
6. INTELLIGENT EYE sensor:
It detects the movements of people and
automatically switches between normal operation
and energy saving operation.
7. Display
8. Air outlet
9. Flap (horizontal blade)
10. Louvers (vertical blades):
The Louvers are inside of the air outlet.
11. Operation lamp (green)
12. TIMER lamp (yellow)
13. HOME LEAVE lamp (red):
Lights up when you use HOME LEAVE
Operation.
14. Indoor Unit ON/OFF switch:
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
The operation mode refer to the following table.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
15. Packaging materials: 50 class only
If any packaging materials are included,
please remove before operating.
16. Room temperature sensor:
It senses the air temperature around the unit.
17. Signal receiver:
It receives signals from the remote controller.
When the unit receives a signal, you will hear a
short beep.
Operation start .............beep-beep
Settings changed..........beep
Operation stop ..............beeeeep
Outdoor Unit
18. Air inlet: (Back and side)
19. Air outlet
20. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
21. Drain hose
22. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
20
21
22
19
18
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow
rate
FTKS COOL 22C AUTO
FTXS AUTO 25C AUTO
Instruction Si18-525B
206 Operation Manual
Remote Controller
1. Signal transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown with all
its displays ON for the purpose of explanation.)
3. HOME LEAVE button:
for HOME LEAVE operation
4. POWERFUL button:
for POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature of time setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(AUTO/DRY/COOL/HEAT/FAN)
8. QUIET button: for OUTDOOR UNIT
QUIET operation
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. SENSOR button: for INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
11. SWING button
Flap (Horizontal blade)
12. SWING button
Louver (Vertical blades)
13. ON TIMER button
14. OFF TIMER button
15. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
16. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
17. CLOCK button
C
ON
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN
SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
SENSOR
1
2
5
6
9
11
10
12
16
17
13
15
14
< ARC433B70, B71 >
3
4
7
8
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 207
FTK(X)D 50/60/71 F
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
1 2
4
3
10
11 9
7
8
15
12
13
14
16
6
5
Instruction Si18-525B
208 Operation Manual
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Air filter
2. Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
3. Air inlet
4. Front panel
5. Panel tab
6. INTELLIGENT EYE sensor:
It detects the movements of people and
automatically switches between normal operation
and energy saving operation.
7. Room temperature sensor:
It senses the air temperature around the unit.
8. Display
9. Air outlet
10. Flap (horizontal blade)
11. Louvers (vertical blades):
The Louvers are inside of the air outlet.
12. Operation lamp (green)
13. TIMER lamp (yellow)
14. HOME LEAVE lamp (red):
Lights up when you use HOME LEAVE
Operation.
15. Indoor Unit ON/OFF switch:
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
The operation mode refer to the following table.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
16. Signal receiver:
It receives signals from the remote controller.
When the unit receives a signal, you will hear a
short beep.
Operation start .............beep-beep
Settings changed..........beep
Operation stop..............beeeeep
Outdoor Unit
17. Air inlet: (Back and side)
18. Air outlet
19. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
20. Drain hose
21. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
19
20
21
18
17
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow
rate
FTKD COOL 22C AUTO
FTXD AUTO 25C AUTO
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 209
Remote Controller
1. Signal transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown with all
its displays ON for the purpose of explanation.)
3. HOME LEAVE button:
HOME LEAVE operation
4. POWERFUL button:
POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(AUTO/DRY/COOL/HEAT/FAN)
8. QUIET button: OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET
operation
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. SENSOR button: INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
11. SWING button:
Flap (Horizontal blade)
12. SWING button:
Louver (Vertical blades)
13. ON TIMER button
14. OFF TIMER button
15. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
16. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
17. CLOCK button
18. RESET button:
Restart the unit if it freezes.
Use a thin object to push.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1
2
5
6
9
11
<
ARC433B70, 71
>
3
4
7
8
10
12
16
18
17
15
14
13
Instruction Si18-525B
210 Operation Manual
FTK 50/60/71 A
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
Opening the front grille
How to open the front grille
CAUTION
Before opening the front grille, be sure to stop the operation and turn the breaker OFF.
If the power is on, the fan may rotate inside and may cause injury.
1 3
4
5
7
6
9 10
12
8
14
13 11
2
15
16
14
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 211
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Air filter
2. Photocatalytic deodorizing filter or
Air purifying filter:
These filters are attached to the inside of the air
filters.
3. Air inlet
4. Front grille
5. Grille tab
6. Diffuser
7. Flap (horizontal blade)
8. Display
9. Air outlet
10. Louvres (vertical blades)
The louvres are inside of the air outlet.
11. Operation lamp (green)
12. TIMER lamp (yellow):
13. HOME LEAVE lamp (red)
Lights up when you use HOME LEAVE
Operation.
14. Indoor Unit ON/OFF switch
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
15. Room temperature sensor:
It senses the air temperature around the unit.
16. Signal receiver:
It receives signals from the remote controller.
When the unit receives a signal, you will hear a
short beep.
Operation start .............beep-beep
Settings changed..........beep
Operation stop ..............beeeeep
The operation mode refer to the following table.
Outdoor Unit
17. Air inlet: (Back and side)
18. Air outlet
19. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
20. Drain hose
21. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
19
20
21
18
17
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow
rate
FTK COOL 22C AUTO
Instruction Si18-525B
212 Operation Manual
Remote Controller
1. Signal transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown with
all its displays ON for the purpose of explana-
tion.)
3. HOME LEAVE button:
for HOME LEAVE operation
4. POWERFUL button:
for POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature of time setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(DRY/COOL/FAN)
8. SILENT button: for OUTDOOR UNIT
SILENT operation
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. SWING button:
Flap (Horizontal blade)
11. SWING button:
Louvre (Vertical blades)
12. ON TIMER button:
13. OFF TIMER button:
14. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
15. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
16. CLOCK button
C
ON
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN
SILENT SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
1
2
5
6
9
10
11
15
16
12
14
13
< ARC433A4 >
3
4
7
8
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 213
FDKS 25/35 C, CDK(X)S 25/35/50/60 C, CDKD 25/35/50/60 C, CDKD 25/35 E
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
3
6
8
9
10
7
1
4 5
2
Instruction Si18-525B
214 Operation Manual
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Air outlet
2. Air outlet grille (Field supply)
Appearance of the Air outlet grille and Air inlet
grille may differ with some models.
3. Display, Control panel
4. Suction grille (Option)
Appearance of the suction grille and Air inlet
grille may differ with some models.
5. Air inlet
6. Room temperature sensor:
It senses the air temperature around the unit.
7. Operation lamp (green)
8.
9. HOME LEAVE lamp (red)
LIghts up when you use HOME LEAVE
operation.
10. Indoor Unit ON/OFF switch
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
The operation mode refers to the following table.
Outdoor Unit
11. Air inlet: (Back and side)
12. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
13. Drain hose
14. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
15. Air outlet
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
12
13
14
15
11
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow
rate
CDKD COOL AUTO 22C
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 215
Remote Controller
1. Signal transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown
with all its displays ON for the purpose of
explanation.)
3. HOME LEAVE button:
HOME LEAVE operation
4. POWERFUL button:
POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(AUTO/DRY/COOL/HEAT/FAN)
8. QUIET button: OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET
operation
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. ON TIMER button:
11. OFF TIMER button:
12. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
13. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
14. CLOCK button
15. RESET button:
Restart the unit if it freezes.
Use a thin object to push.
1
2
5
6
9
13
15
14
10
12
11
< ARC433B76 >
3
4
7
8
Instruction Si18-525B
216 Operation Manual
FLXS 25/35/50/60 B
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
The indoor unit can be installed either to the ceiling or to a wall. The descriptions contained in this man-
ual show the case when installation is being carried out to the ceiling. (The methods of operation used
are the same when installing to a wall.)
Opening the front grille
How to open the front grille :
CAUTION
Before opening the front grille, be sure to stop the operation and turn the breaker OFF.
O N
OFF
1
2
3
4
5
6
11
12
10
7
9
8
13
14
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 217
Outdoor Unit
Indoor Unit
1. Louvers (vertical blades):
The louvers are inside of the air outlet.
2. Air outlet
3. Flap (horizontal blade)
4. Grille tab
5. Air inlet
6. Display
7. Air filter
8. Photocatalytic deodorizing filter or
Air purifying filter:
These filters are attached to the inside of the air
filters.
9. Front grille
10. Operation lamp (green)
11. TIMER lamp (yellow)
12. HOME LEAVE lamp (red):
Lights up when you use HOME LEAVE
Operation.
13. Indoor unit ON/OFF switch:
Push this switch once to start operation.
Push once again to stop it.
The operation mode refers to the following
table.
Push the switch using an object with a sharp
tip, such as a pen.
This switch is useful when the remote controller
is missing.
14. Signal receiver:
It receives signals from the remote controller.
When the unit receives a signal, you will hear a
short beep.
Operation start .............beep-beep
Settings changed..........beep
Operation stop ..............beeeeep
Outdoor Unit
15. Air inlet: (Back and side)
16. Air outlet
17. Refrigerant piping and inter-unit cable
18. Drain hose
19. Earth terminal:
It is inside of this cover.
Appearance of the outdoor unit may differ from some models.
17
18
19
16
15
Mode
Temperature
setting
Air flow rate
AUTO 25C AUTO
Instruction Si18-525B
218 Operation Manual
Remote Controller
1. Signal Transmitter:
It sends signals to the indoor unit.
2. Display:
It displays the current settings.
(In this illustration, each section is shown
with all its displays ON for the purpose of
explanation.)
3. HOME LEAVE button:
for HOME LEAVE operation
4. POWERFUL button:
for POWERFUL operation
5. TEMPERATURE adjustment buttons:
It changes the temperature setting.
6. ON/OFF button:
Press this button once to start operation.
Press once again to stop it.
7. MODE selector button:
It selects the operation mode.
(AUTO/DRY/COOL/HEAT/FAN)
8. QUIET button
9. FAN setting button:
It selects the air flow rate setting.
10. SWING button
11. ON TIMER button
12. OFF TIMER button
13. TIMER Setting button:
It changes the time setting.
14. TIMER CANCEL button:
It cancels the timer setting.
16. RESET button:
Restart the unit if it freezes.
Use a thin object to push.
15. CLOCK button
C
ON
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE FAN SWING
1
2
5
6
9
10
11
13
12
< ARC433B67 >
3
4
7
8
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
14
16
15
QUIET
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 219
FVXS 35/50 B
Names of parts
Indoor Unit
Opening the front grille
How to open the grille:
CAUTION
Before opening the front grille, be sure to stop the operation and turn the breaker OFF.
Do not touch the metal parts on the inside of the indoor unit, as it may result in injury.
ON
OFF
1 2
4
5
2
6
7
8 3
10
14
15
12 13
Air outlet selection switch
This setting blows air from upper outlet only.
This setting automatically decides a blow
pattern depending on mode and conditions.
+
2
3
1
Position and
correctly!
+
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 223
Preparation Before Operation
To operate the remote
controller
To use the remote controller, aim the transmitter at
the indoor unit. If there is anything to block signals
between the unit and the remote controller, such
as a curtain, the unit will not operate.
Do not drop the remote controller. Do not get it wet.
The maximum distance for communication is
about 7m.
To fix the remote controller
holder on the wall
1. Choose a place from where the
signals reach the unit.
2. Fix the holder to a wall, a pillar, or
similar location with the screws
procured locally.
3. Place the remote controller in the
remote controller holder.
ATTENTION
About remote controller
Never expose the remote controller to direct sunlight.
Dust on the signal transmitter or receiver will reduce the sensitivity. Wipe off dust with soft cloth.
Signal communication may be disabled if an electronic-starter-type fluorescent lamp (such as
inverter-type lamps) is in the room. Consult the shop if that is the case.
If the remote controller signals happen to operate another appliance, move that appliance to
somewhere else, or consult the shop.
Receiver
Remote controller
holder
Set.
To remove, pull it upwards.
Instruction Si18-525B
224 Operation Manual
To set the clock
1. Press CLOCK button.
is displayed.
blinks.
2. Press TIMER setting button to
set the clock to the present time.
Holding down or button
rapidly increases or decreases the time
display.
3. Press CLOCK button.
blinks.
Turn the breaker ON
Turning ON the breaker opens the flap, then
closes it again. (This is a normal procedure.)
NOTE
Tips for saving energy
Be careful not to cool (heat) the room too much.
Keeping the temperature setting at a moderate level helps save energy.
Cover windows with a blind or a curtain.
Blocking sunlight and air from outdoors increases the cooling (heating) effect.
Clogged air filters cause inefficient operation and waste energy. Clean them
once in about every two weeks.
Please note
The air conditioner always consumes 15-35 watts of electricity even while it is not operating.
If you are not going to use the air conditioner for a long period, for example in spring or autumn, turn the breaker OFF.
Use the air conditioner in the following conditions.
Operation outside this humidity or temperature range may cause a safety device to disable the system .
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 3
2
Recommended temperature setting
For cooling:26C 28C
For heating:20C 24C
Mode Operating conditions If operation is continued out of this range
COOL Outdoor temperature: <2/3/4MKD> 10 to 46C
<3/4MXD> 10 to 46C
<RK(X)D> 5 to 46C
Indoor temperature: 18 to 32C
Indoor humidity: 80% max.
A safety device may work to stop the operation.
(In multi system, it may work to stop the operation of the
outdoor unit only.)
Condensation may occur on the indoor unit and drip.
HEAT Outdoor temperature: <3/4MXD> 15 to 15.5C
<RXD> 15 to 18C
Indoor temperature: 10 to 30C
A safety device may work to stop the operation.
DRY Outdoor temperature: <2/3/4MKD> 10 to 46C
<3/4MXD> 10 to 46C
<RK(X)D> 5 to 46C
Indoor temperature: 18 to 32C
Indoor humidity: 80% max.
A safety device may work to stop the operation.
Condensation may occur on the indoor unit and drip.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 225
2.2.5 AUTO DRY COOL HEAT FAN Operation
AUTO DRY COOL HEAT FAN Operation
The air conditioner operates with the operation mode of your
choice.
From the next time on, the air conditioner will operate with the
same operation mode.
To start operation
1. Press MODE selector button
and select a operation mode.
Each pressing of the button advances the
mode setting in sequence.
: AUTO
: DRY
: COOL
: HEAT
: FAN
2. Press ON/OFF button.
The OPERATION lamp lights up.
To stop operation
3. Press ON/OFF button again.
Then OPERATION lamp goes off.
To change the temperature setting
4. Press TEMPERATURE adjustment button.
DRY or FAN mode AUTO or COOL or HEAT mode
The temperature setting is not variable.
Press to raise the temperature and press
to lower the temperature.
Set to the temperature you like.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
2, 3
1
4
5
<FTKD>
<FTXD>
Instruction Si18-525B
226 Operation Manual
To change the air flow rate setting
5. Press FAN setting button.
Indoor unit quiet operation
When the air flow is set to , the noise from the indoor unit will become quieter.
Use this when making the noise quieter.
The unit might lose capacity when the air flow rate is set to a weak level.
NOTE
DRY mode AUTO or HEAT or COOL or FAN mode
The air flow rate setting is not variable.
Five levels of air flow rate setting from to
plus are available.
Note on HEAT operation
Since this air conditioner heats the room by taking heat from outdoor air to indoors, the heating
capacity becomes smaller in lower outdoor temperatures. If the heating effect is insufficient, it is
recommended to use another heating appliance in combination with the air conditioner.
The heat pump system heats the room by circulating hot air around all parts of the room. After the
start of heating operation, it takes some time before the room gets warmer.
In heating operation, frost may occur on the outdoor unit and lower the heating capacity. In that case,
the system switches into defrosting operation to take away the frost.
During defrosting operation, hot air does not flow out of indoor unit.
Note on COOL operation
This air conditioner cools the room by blowing the hot air in the room outside, so if the
outside temperature is high, performance drops.
Note on DRY operation
The computer chip works to rid the room of humidity while maintaining the temperature as
much as possible. It automatically controls temperature and fan strength, so manual
adjustment of these functions is unavailable.
Note on AUTO operation
In AUTO operation, the system selects a temperature setting and an appropriate operation mode
(COOL or HEAT) based on the room temperature at the start of the operation.
The system automatically reselects setting at a regular interval to bring the room temperature to
user-setting level.
If you do not like AUTO operation, you can manually select the operation mode and setting
you like.
Note on air flow rate setting
At smaller air flow rates, the cooling (heating) effect is also smaller.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 227
2.2.6 Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
FTK(X)S 20/25/35 D, FTKD 25/35 D
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your com-
fort.
To adjust the horizontal
blades (flaps)
1. Press SWING button.
is displayed on the LCD and the
flaps will begin to swing.
2. When the flaps have reached the
desired position, press SWING
button once more.
The flaps will stop moving.
disappears from the LCD.
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
MODE FAN SWING
SENSOR
ECONO
MOLD PROOF
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
QUIET
1, 2
Instruction Si18-525B
228 Operation Manual
To adjust the vertical blades
(louvres)
Hold the knob and move the louvres.
(You will find a knob on the left-side and the right-side blades.)
When the unit is installed in the corner of a room,
the direction of the louvers should be facing away
from the wall.
If they face the wall, the wall will block off the wind,
causing the cooling (or heating) efficiency to drop.
Notes on flaps and louvres angles
When SWING button is selected, the flaps
swinging range depends on the operation mode.
(See the figure.)
If the unit is operated after being stopped with
the flaps pointed down in cooling or dry opera-
tion, the flaps will automatically move to a hor-
izontal position after about one hour to prevent
condensation from forming on them.
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the flaps
angle. If you attempt to move it forcibly with hand
when it is swinging, the mechanism may be broken.
Be careful when adjusting the louvres. Inside the
air outlet, a fan is rotating at a high speed.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 229
FTK(X)S 50/60/71 B
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your
comfort.
To adjust the horizontal
blade (flap)
1. Press SWING button .
is displayed on the LCD.
2. When the flap has reached the
desired position,
press SWING button once
more.
The flap will stop moving.
To adjust the vertical blades (louvers)
3. Press SWING button .
is displayed on the LCD.
4. When the louvers have reached the desired position, press the
SWING button once more.
The louvers will stop moving.
C
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN
SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
ON
SENSOR
1, 2
3, 4
Instruction Si18-525B
230 Operation Manual
To 3-D Airflow
1. 3. Press the SWING button and the SWING button :
the and display will light up and the flap and louvers will
move in turn.
To cancel 3-D Airflow
2. 4. Press either the SWING button or the SWING button
Notes on louvers angles
Notes on flap angle
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the louvers angles. In side the air outlet, a fan is rotating at a
high speed.
When SWING button is selected, the flaps swinging
range depends on the operation mode. (See the figure.)
Three-Dimensional (3-D) Airflow
Using three-dimensional airflow circulates cold air,
which tends to collected at the bottom of the room, and
hot air, which tends to collect near the ceiling,
throughout the room, preventing areas of cold and hot
developing.
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the flaps angle.
If you attempt to move it forcibly with hand when it is
swinging, the mechanism may be broken.
STOP
COOL
approx. 10~40
DRY
approx. 5~35
In COOL or DRY mode
STOP
HEAT
approx. 15~55
In HEAT or FAN mode
FAN
approx. 5~55
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 231
FTK(X)D 50/60/71 F
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your
comfort.
To adjust the horizontal
blade (flap)
1. Press SWING button .
is displayed on the LCD and the
flaps will begin to swing.
2. When the flap has reached the
desired position,
press SWING button once
more.
The flap will stop moving.
disappears from the LCD.
To adjust the vertical blades (louvers)
3. Press SWING button .
is displayed on the LCD.
4. When the louvers have reached the desired position, press the
SWING button once more.
The louvers will stop moving.
disappears from the LCD.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 2
3, 4
Instruction Si18-525B
232 Operation Manual
To 3-D Airflow
1. 3. Press the SWING button and the SWING button :
the and display will light up and the flap and louvers will
move in turn.
To cancel 3-D Airflow
2. 4. Press either the SWING button or the SWING button .
Notes on louvers angles
Notes on flap angle
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the louvers angles. In side the air outlet, a fan is rotating at a
high speed.
When SWING button is selected, the flaps swinging
range depends on the operation mode. (See the figure.)
Three-Dimensional (3-D) Airflow
Using three-dimensional airflow circulates cold air,
which tends to collected at the bottom of the room, and
hot air, which tends to collect near the ceiling,
throughout the room, preventing areas of cold and hot
developing.
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the flaps angle.
If you attempt to move it forcibly with hand when it is
swinging, the mechanism may be broken.
Be careful when adjusting the louvers. Inside the air
outlet, fan is rotating at a high speed.
STOP
COOL
approx. 10~40
DRY
approx. 5~35
In COOL or DRY mode
STOP
HEAT
approx. 15~55
In HEAT or FAN mode
FAN
approx. 5~55
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 233
FTK 50/60/71 A
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your com-
fort.
To adjust the horizontal
blade (flap)
1. Press SWING button.
The display will light up and the flap will
begin to swing.
2. When the flap have reached the
desired position, press SWING
button once more.
The display will go blank.
The flap will stop moving.
C
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN
SILENT SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
ON
1, 2
3, 4
Instruction Si18-525B
234 Operation Manual
To adjust the vertical blades (louvres)
3. Press SWING button.
The display will light up and the louvres will begin to swing.
4. When the louvres have reached the desired position, press the
SWING button once more.
The display will go blank.
The louvres will stop moving.
Notes on louvres angles
Notes on flap angle
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the louvres angles. In side the air outlet, a fan is rotating at a
high speed.
When [ SWING ] is selected, the flap swinging range depends on the
operation mode. (See the figure.)
The diffuser is kept open in DRY or COOL mode.
NOTE
Unless [ SWING ] is selected, you should set the flap at a nearhorizontal
angle in COOL or DRY mode to obtain the best performance.
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the flap angle. If you attempt to
move it forcibly with hand when it is swinging, the mechanism may be bro-
ken.
DRY COOL
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 235
FLXS 25/35/50/60 B
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your com-
fort.
To adjust the horizontal
blade (flap)
1. Press SWING button.
is displayed on the LCD.
2. When the flaps have reached the
desired position, press SWING
button once more.
The flaps will stop moving.
C
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE FAN SWING
ON
1, 2
QUIET
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
Instruction Si18-525B
236 Operation Manual
To adjust the vertical blades
(louvers)
When adjusting the louver, use a robust and stable stool and
watch your steps carefully.
Hold the knob and move the louvers.
(You will find a knob on the left side and the right side blades.)
Notes on flap and louvers angles
Unless [SWING] is selected, you should set the
flap at a near- horizontal angle in COOL or DRY
mode to obtain the best performance.
In COOL or DRY mode, if the flap is fixed at a
downward position, the flap automatically moves
in about 60 minutes to prevent condensation on it.
ATTENTION
Always use a remote controller to adjust the flap
angle.
If you attempt to move it forcibly with hand when it
is swinging, the mechanism may be broken.
Be careful when adjusting the louvers. Inside the
air outlet, a fan is rotating at a high speed.
DRY
COOL
FAN
HEAT
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 237
FVXS 35/50 B
Adjusting the Air Flow Direction
You can adjust the air flow direction to increase your com-
fort.
To adjust the horizontal
blade (flap)
1. Press SWING button.
is displayed on the LCD.
2. When the flaps have reached the
desired position, press SWING
button once more.
The display will go blank.
The flaps will stop moving.
To adjust the vertical
blades (louvers)
Hold the knob and move the louver.
(You will find a knob on the left-side and the right-side
blades.)
Notes on flap and louvers angle
Unless [ SWING ] is selected, you should set the flap at
a near-horizontal angle in HEAT mode and at a upward
position in COOL or DRY mode to obtain the best
performance.
ATTENTION
When adjusting the flap by hand, turn off the unit, and
use the remote controller to restart the unit.
Be careful when adjusting the louvers. Inside the air
outlet, a fan is rotating at a high speed.
C
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
ON
1, 2
COOL/DRY
HEAT
Instruction Si18-525B
238 Operation Manual
Air flow selection
Make air flow selection according to what suits you.
When setting the air flow selection switch to .
Air conditioner automatically decides the appropriate blowing pattern depending on the operating
mode/situation.
During Dry mode, so that cold air does not come into direct contact with people, air is blown upper air outlet.
When setting the air outlet selection switch to .
Regardless of the operating mode or situation, air blows from the upper air outlet.
Use this switch when you do not want air coming out of the lower air outlet. (While sleeping etc..)
CAUTION
Operating mode Situation Blowing pattern
COOL mode
When the room has become fully
cool, or when one hour has passed
since turning on the air conditioner.
So that air does not come into direct
contact with people, air is blown
upper air outlet, room temperature is
equlised.
At start of operation or other times
when the room is not fully cooled.
Air is blown from the upper and lower
air outlets for high speed cooling dur-
ing COOL mode, and for filling the
room with warm air during HEAT
mode.
HEAT mode
At times other than below.
(Normal time.)
At start or when air temperature is
low.
So that air does not come into direct
contact with people. Air is blown
upper air outlet.
Do not try to adjust the flap by hand.
When adjusting by hand, the mechanism may not operate properly or condensation may drip from
air outlets.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 239
2.2.7 POWERFUL Operation
POWERFUL Operation
POWERFUL operation quickly maximizes the cooling
(heating) effect in any operation mode. You can get the
maximum capacity.
To start POWERFUL
operation
1. Press POWERFUL button.
POWERFUL operation ends in 20 minutes.
Then the system automatically operates
again with the settings which were used
before POWERFUL operation.
When using Powerful operation, there are
some functions which are not available.
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel POWERFUL
operation
2. Press POWERFUL button
again.
disappears from the LCD.
NOTE
Notes on POWERFUL operation
POWERFUL Operation cannot be used together with QUIET Operation. Priority is given to
the function of whichever button is pressed last.
POWERFUL Operation can only be set when the unit is running. Pressing the operation stop button
causes the settings to be canceled, and the disappears from the LCD.
In COOL and HEAT mode
To maximize the cooling (heating) effect, the capacity of outdoor unit must be increased
and the air flow rate be fixed to the maximum setting.
The temperature and air flow settings are not variable.
In DRY mode
The temperature setting is lowered by 2.5C and the air flow rate is slightly increased.
In FAN mode
The air flow rate is fixed to the maximum setting.
When using priority-room setting
See Note for multi system
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 2
Instruction Si18-525B
240 Operation Manual
2.2.8 OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET Operation
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET Operation
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation lowers the noise
level of the outdoor unit by changing the frequency and
fan speed on the outdoor unit. This function is
convenient during night.
To start OUTDOOR UNIT
QUIET operation
1. Press QUIET button.
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel OUTDOOR UNIT
QUIET operation
2. Press QUIET button again.
disappears from the LCD.
NOTE
Note on OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation
If using a multi system, this function will work only when the OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET
operation is set on all operated indoor units.
However, if using priority-room setting, see Note for multi system
This function is available in COOL, HEAT, and AUTO modes.
(This is not available in FAN and DRY mode.)
POWERFUL operation and OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation cannot be used at the
same time.
Priority is given to the function of whichever button is pressed last.
If operation is stopped using the remote controller or the main unit ON/OFF switch when
using OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation, will remain on the remote controller
display.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 2
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 241
2.2.9 ECONO Operation
ECONO Operation
ECONO operation is a function which enables efficient operation by lowering the maximum power con-
sumption value.
To start ECONO operation
1. Press ECONO button .
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel ECONO opera-
tion
2. Press ECONO button again.
disappears from the LCD.
NOTE
ECONO Operation can only be set when the unit is running. Pressing the operation stop
button causes the settings to be canceled, and the disappears from the LCD.
ECONO operation is a function which enables efficient operation by limiting the power
consumption of the outdoor unit (operating frequency).
ECONO operation functions in AUTO, COOL, DRY, and HEAT modes.
POWERFUL operation and ECONO operation cannot be used at the same time.
Priority is given to the function of whichever button is pressed last.
Power consumption may not drop even if ECONO operation is used, when the level of
power consumption is already low.
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
MODE FAN SWING
SENSOR
ECONO
MOLD PROOF
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
QUIET
1, 2
Instruction Si18-525B
242 Operation Manual
2.2.10 MOLD PROOF Operation
MOLD PROOF Operation
MOLD PROOF operation is a function which reduces the spread of mold by using Fan mode to lower
the humidity inside the indoor unit.
To set MOLD PROOF
operation
1. Press and hold the MOLD PROOF
button for two seconds.
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel MOLD PROOF
operation
2. Press and hold the MOLD PROOF
button for two seconds one more
time.
disappears from the LCD.
NOTE
MOLD PROOF operation will operate for approximately one hour after dry or cooling mode
is turned off.
This function is not designed to remove existing dust or mold.
MOLD PROOF operation is not available when the unit is turned off using the OFF TIMER.
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
MODE FAN SWING
SENSOR
ECONO
MOLD PROOF
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
QUIET
1, 2
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 243
2.2.11 HOME LEAVE Operation
HOME LEAVE Operation
HOME LEAVE operation is a function which allows you to record your preferred temperature and air
flow rate settings.
To start HOME LEAVE
operation
1. Press HOME LEAVE button.
is displayed on the LCD.
The HOME LEAVE lamp lights up.
To cancel HOME LEAVE
operation
2. Press HOME LEAVE button again.
disappears from the LCD.
The HOME LEAVE lamp goes off.
Before using HOME LEAVE operation.
To set the temperature and air flow rate for HOME LEAVE operation
When using HOME LEAVE operation for the first time, please set the temperature and air flow rate
for HOME LEAVE operation. Record your preferred temperature and air flow rate.
1. Press HOME LEAVE button. Make sure is displayed in the remote
controller display.
2. Adjust the set temperature with or as you like.
3. Adjust the air flow rate with FAN setting button as you like.
Home leave operation will run with these settings the next time you use the unit. To change
the recorded information, repeat steps 1 3.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 2
Initial setting Selectable range
temperature Air flow rate temperature Air flow rate
Cooling 25C 18-32C 5 step, and
Heating 25C 10-30C 5 step, and
Instruction Si18-525B
244 Operation Manual
Whats the HOME LEAVE operation?
Is there a set temperature and air flow rate which is most comfortable, a set temperature and air flow rate which
you use the most? HOME LEAVE operation is a function that allows you to record your favorite set temperature
and air flow rate. You can start your favorite operation mode simply by pressing the HOME LEAVE button on the
remote controller. This function is convenient in the following situations.
Useful in these cases
1.Use as an energy-saving mode.
Set the temperature 2-3C higher (cooling) or lower (heating) than normal. Setting the fan strength to the lowest
setting allows the unit to be used in energy-saving mode. Also convenient for use while you are out or sleeping.
Every day before you leave the house...
Before bed...
2.Use as a favorite mode.
Once you record the temperature and air flow rate settings you most often use, you can retrieve them by
pressing HOME LEAVE button. You do not have to go through troublesome remote control operations.
NOTE
When you go out, push the HOME LEAVE
Operation button, and the air conditioner
will adjust capacity to reach the preset
temperature for HOME LEAVE Operation.
When you return, you will be
welcomed by a comfortably air
conditioned room.
Push the HOME LEAVE Operation
button again, and the air conditioner
will adjust capacity to the set
temperature for normal operation.
Set the unit to HOME LEAVE
Operation before leaving the living
room when going to bed.
The unit will maintain the
temperature in the room at a
comfortable level while you sleep.
When you enter the living room in the
morning, the temperature will be just right.
Disengaging HOME LEAVE Operation
will return the temperature to that set
for normal operation. Even the coldest
winters will pose no problem!
Once the temperature and air flow rate for HOME LEAVE operation are set, those settings will be
used whenever HOME LEAVE operation is used in the future. To change these settings, please refer
to the Before using HOME LEAVE operation section above.
HOME LEAVE operation is only available in COOL and HEAT mode. Cannot be used in AUTO, DRY,
and FAN mode.
HOME LEAVE operation runs in accordance with the previous operation mode (COOL or HEAT)
before using HOME LEAVE operation.
HOME LEAVE operation and POWERFUL operation cannot be used at the same time.
Last button that was pressed has priority.
The operation mode cannot be changed while HOME LEAVE operation is being used.
When operation is shut off during HOME LEAVE operation, using the remote controller or the indoor
unit ON/OFF switch, will remain on the remote controller display.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 245
2.2.12 INTELLIGENT EYE Operation
FTK(X)S 20/25/35 D, FTKD 25/35 D
INTELLIGENT EYE Operation
INTELLIGENT EYE is the infrared sensor which
detects the human movement.
To start INTELLIGENT
EYE operation
1. Press SENSOR button.
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel the
INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
2. Press SENSOR button again.
disappears from the LCD.
[EX.]
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
MODE FAN SWING
SENSOR
ECONO
MOLD PROOF
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
QUIET
1, 2
When somebody in the room
Normal operation
When nobody in the room
20 min. after, start energy saving
operation.
Somebody back in the room
Back to normal operation.
Instruction Si18-525B
246 Operation Manual
INTELLIGENT EYE is useful for Energy Saving
Notes on INTELLIGENT EYE
CAUTION
Energy saving operation
Change the temperature 2C in heating / +2C in cooling / +2C in dry mode from set temperature.
Decrease the air flow rate slightly in fan operation. (In FAN mode only)
Application range is as follows.
Sensor may not detect moving objects further than 7m away. (Check the application range)
Sensor detection sensitivity changes according to indoor unit location, the speed of pass-
ersby, temperature range, etc.
The sensor also mistakenly detects pets, sunlight, fluttering curtains and light reflected off of
mirrors as passersby.
INTELLIGENT EYE operatipon will not go on during powerful operation.
Night set mode will not go on during you use INTELLIGENT EYE operation.
Do not place large objects near the sensor.
Also keep heating units or humidifiers outside the sensors detection area. This sensor can
detect objects it shouldnt as well as not detect objects it should.
Do not hit or violently push the INTELLIGENT EYE sensor. This can lead to damage and
malfunction.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 247
FTK(X)S 50/60/71 B
INTELLIGENT EYE Operation
INTELLIGENT EYE is the infrared sensor which
detects the human movement.
To start INTELLIGENT
EYE operation
1. Press SENSOR button.
To cancel the
INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
2. Press SENSOR button again.
[EX.]
When somebody in the room
Normal operation
When nobody in the room
20 min. after, start energy saving
operation.
Somebody back in the room
Back to normal operation.
C
TEMP
ON/OFF
POWERFUL
HOME LEAVE
MODE
TIMER
FAN SWING
ON CANCEL
OFF
SWING
1, 2
SENSOR
Instruction Si18-525B
248 Operation Manual
INTELLIGENT EYE is useful for Energy Saving
Notes on INTELLIGENT EYE
CAUTION
Energy saving operation
Change the temperature 2C in heating / +2C in cooling / +1C in dry mode from set temperature.
Decrease the air flow rate slightly in fan operation. (In FAN mode only)
Application range is as follows.
Sensor may not detect moving objects further than 7m away. (Check the application range)
Sensor detection sensitivity changes according to indoor unit location, the speed of
passersby, temperature range, etc.
The sensor also mistakenly detects pets, sunlight, fluttering curtains and light reflected off of
mirrors as passersby.
INTELLIGENT EYE operation will not go on during powerful operation.
Night set mode will not go on during you use INTELLIGENT EYE operation.
Do not place large objects near the sensor.
Also keep heating units or humidifiers outside the sensors detection area. This sensor can
detect objects it shouldnt as well as not detect objects it should.
Do not hit or violently push the INTELLIGENT EYE sensor. This can lead to damage and
malfunction.
90
55
7
m
55
7
m
Vertical angle 90
(Side View)
Horizontal angle 110
(Top View)
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 249
FTK(X)D 50/60/71 F
INTELLIGENT EYE Operation
INTELLIGENT EYE is the infrared sensor which
detects the human movement.
To start INTELLIGENT
EYE operation
1. Press SENSOR button.
is displayed on the LCD.
To cancel the
INTELLIGENT EYE
operation
2. Press SENSOR button again.
disappears from the LCD.
[EX.]
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
1, 2
When somebody in the room
Normal operation
When nobody in the room
20 min. after, start energy saving
operation.
Somebody back in the room
Back to normal operation.
Instruction Si18-525B
250 Operation Manual
INTELLIGENT EYE is useful for Energy Saving.
Notes on INTELLIGENT EYE
CAUTION
Energy saving operation
Change the temperature 2C in heating / +2C in cooling / +1C in dry mode from set temperature.
Decrease the air flow rate slightly in fan operation. (In FAN mode only)
Application range is as follows.
Sensor may not detect moving objects further than 7m away. (Check the application range)
Sensor detection sensitivity changes according to indoor unit location, the speed of
passersby, temperature range, etc.
The sensor also mistakenly detects pets, sunlight, fluttering curtains and light reflected off of
mirrors as passersby.
INTELLIGENT EYE operation will not go on during powerful operation.
Night set mode will not go on during you use INTELLIGENT EYE operation.
Do not place large objects near the sensor.
Also keep heating units or humidifiers outside the sensors detection area. This sensor can
detect objects it shouldnt as well as not detect objects it should.
Do not hit or violently push the INTELLIGENT EYE sensor. This can lead to damage and
malfunction.
90
55
7
m
55
7
m
Vertical angle 90
(Side View)
Horizontal angle 110
(Top View)
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 251
2.2.13 TIMER Operation
TIMER Operation
Timer functions are useful for automatically switching the
air conditioner on or off at night or in the morning. You can
also use OFF TIMER and ON TIMER in combination.
To use OFF TIMER
operation
Check that the clock is correct.
If not, set the clock to the present time.
1. Press OFF TIMER button.
is displayed.
blinks.
2. Press TIMER Setting button
until the time setting reaches the
point you like.
Every pressing of either button increases
or decreases the time setting by 10
minutes. Holding down either button
changes the setting rapidly.
3. Press OFF TIMER button
again.
The TIMER lamp lights up.
To cancel the OFF TIMER Operation
4. Press CANCEL button.
The TIMER lamp goes off.
NOTE
When TIMER is set, the present time is not displayed.
Once you set ON, OFF TIMER, the time setting is kept in the memory. (The memory is canceled when
remote controller batteries are replaced.)
When operating the unit via the ON/OFF Timer, the actual length of operation may vary from the time
entered by the user. (Maximum approx. 10 minutes)
NIGHT SET MODE
When the OFF TIMER is set, the air conditioner automatically adjusts the temperature setting (0.5C
up in COOL, 2.0C down in HEAT) to prevent excessive cooling (heating) for your pleasant sleep.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
4
2
1, 3
Instruction Si18-525B
252 Operation Manual
To use ON TIMER operation
Check that the clock is correct. If not, set the
clock to the present time.
1. Press ON TIMER button.
is displayed.
blinks.
2. Press TIMER Setting button
until the time setting reaches the
point you like.
Every pressing of either button increases or
decreases the time setting by 10 minutes.
Holding down either button changes the
setting rapidly.
3. Press ON TIMER button again.
The TIMER lamp lights up.
To cancel ON TIMER operation
4. Press CANCEL button.
The TIMER lamp goes off.
To combine ON TIMER and OFF TIMER
A sample setting for combining the two timers is shown below.
ATTENTION
In the following cases, set the timer again.
After a breaker has turned OFF.
After a power failure.
After replacing batteries in the remote controller.
TIMER
ON CANCEL
OFF
2
1, 3
4
(Example)
Present time: 11:00 p.m.
(The unit operating)
OFF TIMER at 0:00 a.m.
ON TIMER at 7:00 a.m.
Combined
D
is
p
la
y
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 253
2.2.14 Note for Multi System
Note for Multi System
What is a Multi System?
This system has one outdoor unit connected to multiple indoor units.
Selecting the Operation Mode
1. With the Priority Room Setting
present but inactive or not present.
When more than one indoor unit is operating, priority is
given to the first unit that was turned on.
In this case, set the units that are turned on later to the
same operation mode (*1) as the first unit.
Otherwise, they will enter the Standby Mode, and the operation lamp will flash; this does not indicate malfunction.
(*1)
COOL, DRY and FAN mode may be used at the same time.
AUTO mode automatically selects COOL mode or HEAT mode based on the room temperature.
Therefore, AUTO mode is available when selecting the same operation mode as that of the room
with the first unit to be turned on.
CAUTION
Normally, the operation mode in the room where the unit is first run is given priority, but the following situations are
exceptions, so please keep this in mind.
If the operation mode of the first room is FAN Mode, then using Heating Mode in any room after this will give priority to
heating. In this situation, the air conditioner running in FAN Mode will go on standby, and the operation lamp will flash.
2. With the Priority Room Setting active.
See Priority Room Setting on the next page.
NIGHT QUIET Mode (Available only for cooling operation)
NIGHT QUIET Mode requires initial programming during installation. Please consult your retailer or dealer for assistance.
NIGHT QUIET Mode reduces the operation noise of the outdoor unit during the night time hours to prevent
annoyance to neighbors.
The NIGHT QUIET Mode is activated when the temperature drops 5C or more below the highest temperature
recorded that day. Therefore, when the temperature difference is less than 5C, this function will not be activated.
NIGHT QUIET Mode reduces slightly the cooling efficiency of the unit.
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET Operation
1. With the Priority Room Setting present but inactive or not present.
When using the OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation feature with the Multi system, set all indoor units to
OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation using their remote controllers.
When clearing OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation, clear one of the operating indoor units using their remote controller.
However OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation display remains on the remote controller for other rooms.
We recommend you release all rooms using their remote controllers.
2. With the Priority Room Setting active.
See Priority Room Setting on the next page.
Cooling / Heating Mode Lock (Available only for heat pump models)
The Cooling / Heating Mode Lock requires initial programming during installation.Please consult your retailer or dealer
for assistance. The Cooling / Heating Mode Lock sets the unit forcibly to either Cooling or Heating Mode. This function
is convenient when you wish to set all indoor units connected to the Multi system to the same operation mode.
C
room
B
room
A
room
D
room
C
room
B
room
A
room
D
room
Outdoor
unit
Instruction Si18-525B
254 Operation Manual
Priority Room Setting
The Priority Room Setting requires initial programming during installation. Please consult your
retailer or dealer for assistance.
The room designated as the Priority Room takes priority in the following situations;
1. Operation Mode Priority.
As the operation mode of the Priority Room takes precedence, the user can select a different
operation mode from other rooms.
Example
* Room A is the Priority Room in the examples.
When COOL mode is selected in Room A while operating the following modes in Room B,C and D:
2. Priority when POWERFUL operation is used.
Example
* Room A is the Priority Room in the examples.
The indoor units in Rooms A,B,C and D are all operating. If the unit in Room A enters POWERFUL
operation, operation capacity will be concentrated in Room A. In such a case, the cooling (heating)
efficiency of the units in Rooms B,C and D may be slightly reduced.
3. Priority when using OUTDOOR UNIT QUIET operation.
Example
* Room A is the Priority Room in the examples.
Just by setting the unit in Room A to QUIET operation, the air conditioner starts OUTDOOR UNIT
QUIET operation.
You dont have to set all the operated indoor units to QUIET operation.
When the simultaneous operational capacity is
exceeded
If the simultaneous operational capacity is exceeded for outdoor unit capacity, the indoor unit
enters Standby Mode, and the operation light flashed; this is not a malfunction.
<Example>
When the units in rooms A, B, and C are being used, and the D is used, causing an overload:
The room (from A to D) which is closest to the set temperature will go into standby mode. The
room in standby mode will resume operation once operation in the other rooms is stopped.
Operation mode in Room B, C and D Status of Room B, C and D when the unit in Room A is in COOL mode
COOL or DRY or FAN Current operation mode maintained
HEAT
The unit enters Standby Mode. Operation resumes when the
Room A unit stops operating.
AUTO
If the unit is set to COOL mode, operation continues. If set to
HEAT mode, it enters Standby Mode. Operation resumes when
the Room A unit stops operating.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 255
2.2.15 Care and Cleaning
FTK(X)S 20/25/35 D, FTKD 25/35 D
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front panel
1. Open the front panel.
Hold the panel by the tabs on the two sides and lift
it unitl it stops with a click.
2. Remove the front panel.
Lift the front panel up, slide it slightly to the
right, and remove it from the horizontal axle.
3. Clean the front panel.
Wipe it with a soft cloth soaked in water.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the panel with water, dry it with
cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
4. Attach the front panel.
Set the 2 keys of the front panel into the slots and
push them in all the way.
Close the front panel slowly and push the panel at
the 3 points.
( 1 on each side and 1 in the middle.)
CAUTION
Units
Dont touch the metal parts of the indoor unit. If you touch those parts, this may cause an injury.
When removing or attaching the front panel, use a robust and stable stool and watch your steps carefully.
When removing or attaching the front panel, support the panel securely with hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40C, benzine, gasoline, thinner, nor other volatile oils, pol-
ishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front panel is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
Instruction Si18-525B
256 Operation Manual
1. Open the front panel.
2. Pull out the air filters.
Push a little upwards the tab at the center of each air
filter, then pull it down.
3. Take off the Titanium Apatite
Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter.
Hold the recessed parts of the frame and
unhook the four claws.
4. Clean or replace each filter.
See figure.
5. Set the air filter and Titanium Apatite
Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter as they
were and close the front panel.
Insert claws of the filters into slots of the front panel.
Close the front panel slowly and push the panel at the 3
points. (1 on each side and 1 in the middle.)
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them with
vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral detergent
thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter.
The Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter can be renewed
by washing it with water once every 6 months. We recommend replacing
it once every 3 years.
[ Maintenance ]
1. Remove dust with a vacuum cleaner and wash lightly with water.
2. If it is very dirty, soak it for 10 to 15 minutes in water mixed with a neu-
tral cleaning agent.
3. Do not remove filter from frame when washing with water.
4. After washing, shake off remaining water and dry in the shade.
5. Since the material is made out of paper, do not wring out the filter
when removing water from it.
[ Replacement ]
1. Remove the tabs on the filter frame and replace with a new filter.
Dispose of the old filter as flammable waste.
Filters
Air filter
Titanium Apatite
Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter
Filter frame
Tab
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 257
NOTE
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the Fan only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE selector button and select Fanoperation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the
other room before you use the fan operation.
Operation with dirty filters:
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
To order Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter contact to the service shop
there you bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old filters as burnable waste.
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the ser-
vice shop if this is the case.
Item Part No.
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter.
(without frame) 1 set
KAF970A46
Instruction Si18-525B
258 Operation Manual
FTK(X)S 50/60/71 B
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front grille
1. Open the front grille.
Hold the grille by the tabs on the two sides
and lift it until it stops with a click.
2. Remove the front grille.
Open the front panel further while
sliding it to either the left or right and
pulling it toward you. This will disconnect
the rotation dowel on one side. Then
disconnect the rotation dowel on the
other side in the same manner.
3. Clean the front grille
Wipe it with a soft cloth soaked in water.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the grille with water, dry it with cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
4. Attach the front grille
Align the rotation dowels on the left and right of the front panel with
the slots, then push them all the way in.
Close the front panel slowly. (Press the panel at both sides and the
center.)
CAUTION
Units
When the packaging materials are attached to the front panel, please remove
them.
Dont touch the metal parts of the indoor unit. If you touch those parts,
this may cause an injury.
When removing or attaching the front grille, use a robust and stable stool
and watch your steps carefully.
When removing or attaching the front grille, support the grille securely with
hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40 C, benzine, gasoline,
thinner, nor other volatile oils, polishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front grille is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 259
1. Open the front grille.
2. Pull out the air filters.
Push a little upwards the tab at the center of
each air filter, then pull it down.
3. Take off the air
purifying filter with
photocatalytic
deodorizing function.
Press the top of the air-
cleaning filter onto the tabs
(3 tabs at top). Then press
the bottom of the filter up
slightly, and press it onto the
tabs (2 at bottom)(3 at
bottom).
4. Clean or replace each filter.
See below.
5. Set the air filter, air purifying filter with
photocalytic deodorizing function as they
were and close the front grille.
Press the front panel at both sides and the center.
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them with vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral detergent
thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Air purifying filter with photocatalytic deodorizing function. (gray)
The air purifying filter with photocatalytic deodorizing function can be renewed by washing it with
water once every 6 months. We recommend replacing it once every 3 years.
[ Maintenance ]
1. Remove dust with a vacuum cleaner and wash lightly with water.
2. If it is very dirty, soak it for 10 to 15 minutes in water mixed with a neutral cleaning agent.
3. After washing, shake off remaining water and dry in the shade.
4. Since the material is made out of paper, do not wring out the filter when removing water from it.
[ Replacement ]
1. Remove the tabs on the filter frame and replace with a new filter.
Dispose of the old filter as flammable waste.
Filters
tabs (3 tabs at top)
tabs (2 at bottom)
50class
tabs (3 tabs at top)
tabs (3 at bottom)
60,71class
Instruction Si18-525B
260 Operation Manual
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the FAN only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE button and select FAN operation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
NOTE
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the
service shop if this is the case.
Operation with dirty filters:
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
To order air purifying filter with photocatalytic deodorizing function contact to the service shop there
you bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old air filter as non-burnable and photocatalytic deodorizing filters as burnable
waste.
Item Part No.
Air purifying filter with photocatalytic deodorizing
function. (without frame) 1 set
KAF952A42
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 261
FTK(X)D 50/60/71 F
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front panel
1. Open the front panel.
Hold the panel by the tabs on the two
sides and lift it until it stops with a
click.
2. Remove the front panel.
Open the front panel further while sliding
it to either the left or right and pulling it
toward you. This will disconnect the
rotation dowel on one side. Then
disconnect the rotation dowel on the
other side in the same manner.
3. Clean the front panel.
Wipe it with a soft cloth soaked in water.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the panel with water, dry it with cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
4. Attach the front panel.
Align the rotation dowels on the left and right of the front panel
with the slots, then push them all the way in.
Close the front panel slowly. (Press the panel at both sides
and the center.)
CAUTION
Units
Dont touch the metal parts of the indoor unit. If you touch those parts, this may cause an injury.
When removing or attaching the front panel, use a robust and stable stool and watch your steps carefully.
When removing or attaching the front panel, support the panel securely with hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40C, benzine, gasoline, thinner, nor other volatile oils,
polishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front panel is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
Instruction Si18-525B
262 Operation Manual
1. Open the front panel.
2. Pull out the air filters.
Push a little upwards the tab at the
center of each air filter, then pull it
down.
3. Take off the Titanium
Apatite Photocatalytic
Air-Purifying Filter.
Press the top of the air-
cleaning filter onto the tabs
(3 tabs at top). Then press
the bottom of the filter up
slightly, and press it onto
the tabs (3 at bottom).
4. Clean or replace each filter.
See figure.
5. Set the air filter and the Titanium
Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying
Filter as they were and close the
front panel.
Press the front panel at both sides and the
center.
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them with
vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral
detergent thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the
shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-purifying Filter
The Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter can be renewed by washing it with water
once every 6 months. We recommend replacing it once every 3 years.
[ Maintenance ]
1. Remove dust with a vacuum cleaner and wash lightly with water.
2. If it is very dirty, soak it for 10 to 15 minutes in water mixed with a neutral cleaning agent.
3. After washing, shake off remaining water and dry in the shade.
4. Since the material is made out of polyester, do not wring out the filter when removing water
from it.
[ Replacement ]
1. Remove the tabs on the filter frame and replace with a new filter.
Dispose of the old filter as non-flammable waste.
Filters
tabs (3 tabs at top)
tabs (3 at bottom)
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 263
NOTE
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the FAN only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE button and select FAN operation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
NOTE) When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not
used at the other room before you use the fan operation.
Operation with dirty filters:
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
To order Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter contact to the service shop
there you bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old filters as non-flammable waste.
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the
service shop if this is the case.
Item Part No.
Titanium Apatite Photocatalytic Air-Purifying Filter
(without frame) 1 set
KAF952B42
Instruction Si18-525B
264 Operation Manual
FTK 50/60/71 A
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front grille
1. Open the front grille.
Hold the grille by the tabs on the two sides and lift
it unitl it stops with a click.
2. Remove the front grille.
Supporting the front grille with one hand, release
the lock by sliding down the knob with the other
hand.
To remove the front grille, pull it toward yourself
with both hands.
3. Clean the front grille
Wipe it with a soft cloth soaked in water.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the grille with water, dry it with
cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
4. Attach the front grille
Set the 4 keys of the front grille into the slots
and push them in all the way.
Close the front grille slowly and push the grille
at the 4 points.
(1 on each side and 2 in the middle.)
Check to see if the rotating axis in the upper
center section is moving.
CAUTION
Units
Dont touch the metal parts of the indoor unit. If you touch those parts, this may cause an injury.
When removing or attaching the front grille, use a robust and stable stool and watch your steps carefully.
When removing or attaching the front grille, support the grille securely with hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40 C, benzine, gasoline, thinner, nor other volatile oils, pol-
ishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front grille is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
C
Fit the key
into the slot.
Slide up the knob.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 265
1. Open the front grille.
2. Pull out the air filters.
Push a little upwards the tab at the center of each air
filter, then pull it down.
3. Take off the air purifying filter,
photocatalytic deodorizing filter.
Hold the recessed parts of the frame and unhook
the four claws.
4. Clean or replace each filter.
w.
5. Set the air filter, air purifying filter
and photocatalytic deodorizing filter as
they were and close the front grille.
Insert claws of the filters into slots of the front grille.
Close the front grille slowly and push the grille at the 4
points. (1 on each side and 2 in the middle.)
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them with
vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral detergent
thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Air Purifying Filter (green)
(Replace approximately once every 3 months.)
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Insert with the green side up.
It is recommended to replace the air purifying filter every three months.
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter (gray)
[ Maintenance ]
1. Dry the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun.
After removing the dust with a vacuum cleaner, place the filter in the sun for approximately 6 hours.
By drying the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun, its deodorizing and antibacterial capabilities
are regenerated.
Because the filter material is paper, it can not be cleaned with water.
It is recommended dry the filter once every 6 months.
[ Replacement ]
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Filters
C
Air filter
Air purifying
filter or
Photocataltyic
deodorizing
filter
Push
See belo
Instruction Si18-525B
266 Operation Manual
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the fan only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE button and select fanoperation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. Clean the air filters and set them again.
3. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
4. Turn OFF the breaker for the room air conditioner.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the other room
before you use the fan operation.
NOTE
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the earth wire is not disconnected or broken.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the ser-
vice shop if this is the case.
Operation with dirty filters :
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
The air purifying filter and Photocatalytic deodorizing filter cannot be reused, even if washed.
In principle, there is no need to replace the photocatalytic deodorizing filter. Remove the dust peri-
odically with a vacuum cleaner. However, it is recommended to replace the filter in the following
cases.
(1) The paper material is torn or broken during cleaning.
(2) The filter has become extremely dirty after long use.
To order air purifying filter or Photocatalytic deodorizing filter, contact to the service shop where you
bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old air filters as non-burnable waste and Photocatalytic deodorizing filters as
burnable waste.
Item Part No.
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (with frame) KAZ917B41
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (without frame) KAZ917B42
Air purifying filter (with frame) KAF925B41
Air purifying filter (without frame) KAF925B42
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 267
FDKS 25/35 C, CDK(X)S 25/35/50/60 C, CDKD 25/35/50/60 C
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Cleaning the air filter and suction grille (Option)
Be sure always to clean the unit before use at the beginning of summer and winter.
(Dirt and dust caught in the air filter cause a drop in airflow, which leads to a decline in performance.)
When using the unit in a location where dirt may easily accumulate, clean the unit more frequently.
Once every 2 weeks is recommended.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer how to clean them.
Cleaning the drain pan
Clean the drain pan periodically, or drain piping may be clogged with dust and may result in water leakage.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer how to clean them.
If the ambient air of indoor unit is so dusty, install the optional Dust Cover which prevent dust from falling
into drain pan.
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the Fan only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE button and select Fanoperation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the
other room before you use the fan operation.
NOTE
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the ser-
vice shop if this is the case.
Do not use gasoline, benzene, thinner, polishing powder, liquid insecticide, It may cause discoloring or
warping.
Do not let the indoor unit get wet. It may cause an electric shock or a fire.
Operation with dusty air filters lowers the cooling and heating capacity and wastes energy.
The air filter and the suction grille are option.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer how to clean them.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
Instruction Si18-525B
268 Operation Manual
CDKD 25/35 E
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Cleaning the air filter and suction grille (Option)
Be sure always to clean the unit before use at the beginning of summer and winter.
(Dirt and dust caught in the air filter cause a drop in airflow, which leads to a decline in performance.)
When using the unit in a location where dirt may easily accumulate, clean the unit more frequently.
Once every 2 weeks is recommended.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer how to clean them.
Cleaning the drain pan
Clean the drain pan periodically, or drain piping may be clogged with dust and may result in water leakage.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer to clean them.
Prepare a cover locally to prevent any dust in the air around the indoor unit from getting in the drain pan, if
there is a great deal of dust present.
CAUTION
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the FAN only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the inside.
Press MODE selector button and select FAN operation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the
other room before you use the fan operation.
Do not operate the air conditioner without filters, this to avoid dust accumulation inside the unit.
Do not remove the air filter except when cleaning.
Unnecessary handling may damage the filter.
Do not use gasoline, benzene, thinner, polishing powder, liquid insecticide. It may cause discoloring or warping.
Do not let the indoor unit get wet. It may cause an electric shock or a fire.
Operation with dusty air filters lowers the cooling and heating capacity and wastes energy.
Do not use water or air of 50C or higher for cleaning air filters and outside panels.
The air filter and the suction grille are option.
Ask your DAIKIN dealer how to clean them.
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the
service shop if this is the case.
Only a qualified service person is allowed to
perform maintenance.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 269
FLXS 25/35/50/60 B
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front grille
1. Open the front grille.
Hold the grille by the tabs on the two sides and lift
it unitl it stops.
2. Clean the front grille
Wipe it with a soft cloth soaked in water.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the grille with water, dry it with
cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
3. Close the front grille
Push the grille at the 5 points indicated by .
Operation without air filters may result in troubles
as dust will accumulate inside the indoor unit.
CAUTION
Units
Dont touch the metal parts of the indoor unit. If you touch those parts, this may cause an injury.
When opening and closing the front grille, use a robust and stable stool and watch your steps carefully.
When opening and closing the front grille, support the grille securely with hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40 C, benzine, gasoline, thinner, nor other volatile oils, pol-
ishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front grille is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
O NOFF
O NOFF
Instruction Si18-525B
270 Operation Manual
1. Open the front grille.
2. Pull out the air filters.
Push upwards the tab at the center of each air fil-
ter, then pull it down.
3. Take off the air purifying filter,
photocatalytic deodorizing filter.
Hold the recessed parts of the frame and unhook
the four claws.
4. Clean or replace each filter.
See figure.
5. Set the air filter, air purifying filter
and photocatalytic deodorizing filter as
they were and close the front grille.
Insert claws of the filters into slots of the front grille.
Push the grille at the 5 points.
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them
with vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral deter-
gent thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Air Purifying Filter (green)
(Replace approximately once every 3 months.)
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Insert with the green side up.
It is recommended to replace the air purifying filter every three months.
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter (gray)
[ Maintenance ]
1. Dry the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun.
After removing the dust with a vacuum cleaner, place the filter in the sun for approximately 6 hours.
By drying the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun, its deodorizing and antibacterial capabilities
are regenerated.
Because the filter material is paper, it can not be cleaned with water.
It is recommended dry the filter once every 6 months.
[ Replacement ]
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Filters
O NOFF
Air purifying filter
or Photocatalytic
deodorizing filter
O NOFF
O NOFF
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 271
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the FAN only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE selector button and select FAN operation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the other room
before you use the fan operation.
NOTE
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the ser-
vice shop if this is the case.
Operation with dirty filters :
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
The air purifying filter and Photocatalytic deodorizing filter cannot be reused, even if washed.
In principle, there is no need to replace the photocatalytic deodorizing filter. Remove the dust peri-
odically with a vacuum cleaner. However, it is recommended to replace the filter in the following
cases.
(1) The paper material is torn or broken during cleaning.
(2) The filter has become extremely dirty after long use.
To order air purifying filter or Photocatalytic deodorizing filter, contact to the service shop where you
bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old air filters as non-burnable waste and Photocatalytic deodorizing filters as
burnable waste.
Item Part No.
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (with frame) KAZ917B41
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (without frame) KAZ917B42
Air purifying filter (with frame) KAF925B41
Air purifying filter (without frame) KAF925B42
Instruction Si18-525B
272 Operation Manual
FVXS 35/50 B
Care and Cleaning
CAUTION
Indoor unit, Outdoor unit and Remote controller
1. Wipe them with dry soft cloth.
Front grille
1. Open the front grille.
Press the two places on the left and right of
the front grille.
2. Remove the front grille.
Remove the chain.
Allowing the grille to fall forward will enable you to
remove it.
3. Clean the front grille
Wipe softly with a damp cloth.
Only neutral detergent may be used.
In case of washing the grille with water, dry it with
cloth, dry it up in the shade after washing.
4. Attach the front grille.
Insert the front grille into the grooves of the unit
(3 places).
Attach the chain to the right, inner-side of the front
grille.
Close the grille slowly.
CAUTION
Units
Hold the front grille firmly so that it does not fall.
Do not touch the metal parts on the inside of the indoor unit, as it may result in injury.
When removing or attaching the front grille, use a robust and stable stool and watch your steps carefully.
When removing or attaching the front grille, support the grille securely with hand to prevent it from falling.
For cleaning, do not use hot water above 40 C, benzine, gasoline, thinner, nor other volatile oils, pol-
ishing compound, scrubbing brushes, nor other hand stuff.
After cleaning, make sure that the front grille is securely fixed.
Before cleaning, be sure to stop the operation and
turn the breaker OFF.
P U S H
Chain
Place front grille in grooves.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 273
1. Open the front grille.
2. Remove the air filter.
Press the claws on the right and left of the air filter down
slightly, then pull upward.
3. Take off the air purifying filter,
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter.
Hold the tabs of the frame, and remove the claws in 4 places.
4. Clean or replace each filter.
See below.
5. Set the air filter, air purifying filter
and photocatalytic deodorizing
filter as they were and close the
front grille.
Operation without air filters may result in troubles
as dust will accumulate inside the indoor unit.
Air Filter
1. Wash the air filters with water or clean them with
vacuum cleaner.
If the dust does not come off easily, wash them with neutral detergent
thinned with lukewarm water, then dry them up in the shade.
It is recommended to clean the air filters every two weeks.
Air Purifying Filter (green)
(Replace approximately once every 3 months.)
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Insert with the green side up.
It is recommended to replace the air purifying filter every three months.
Photocatalytic Deodorizing Filter (gray)
[ Maintenance ]
1. Dry the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun.
After removing the dust with a vacuum cleaner, place the filter in the sun for approximately 6 hours.
By drying the photocatalytic deodorizing filter in the sun, its deodorizing and antibacterial capabilities
are regenerated.
Because the filter material is paper, it can not be cleaned with water.
It is recommended dry the filter once every 6 months.
[ Replacement ]
1. Detach the filter element and attach a new one.
Filters
Air filter
Air purifying filter
or photocatalytic
deodorizing filter
Instruction Si18-525B
274 Operation Manual
Check
Before a long idle period
1. Operate the FAN only for several hours on a fine day to dry out the
inside.
Press MODE selector button and select FAN operation.
Press ON/OFF button and start operation.
2. After operation stops, turn off the breaker for the room air conditioner.
3. Clean the air filters and set them again.
4. Take out batteries from the remote controller.
When a multi outdoor unit is connected, make sure the heating operation is not used at the other room
befure you use the fan operation.
NOTE
Check that the base, stand and other fittings of the outdoor unit are not decayed or corroded.
Check that nothing blocks the air inlets and the outlets of the indoor unit and the outdoor unit.
Check that the drain comes smoothly out of the drain hose during COOL or DRY operation.
If no drain water is seen, water may be leaking from the indoor unit. Stop operation and consult the ser-
vice shop if this is the case.
Operation with dusty air filters lowers the cooling (heating) capacity and wastes energy.
Air is also prevented from flowing smoothly through the unit creating a noise.
Operation with dirty filters :
(1) cannot deodorize the air. (2) cannot clean the air.
(3) results in poor heating or cooling. (4) may cause odour.
The air purifying filter and Photocatalytic deodorizing filter cannot be reused, even if washed.
In principle, there is no need to replace the photocatalytic deodorizing filter. Remove the dust peri-
odically with a vacuum cleaner. However, it is recommended to replace the filter in the following
cases.
(1) The paper material is torn or broken during cleaning.
(2) The filter has become extremely dirty after long use.
To order air purifying filter or Photocatalytic deodorizing filter, contact to the service shop where you
bought the air conditioner.
Dispose of old air filters as non-burnable waste and Photocatalytic deodorizing filters as
burnable waste.
Item Part No.
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (with frame) KAZ917B41
Photocatalytic deodorizing filter (without frame) KAZ917B42
Air purifying filter (with frame) KAF925B41
Air purifying filter (without frame) KAF925B42
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 275
2.2.16 Troubleshooting
Trouble Shooting
The following cases are not air conditioner troubles but have some reasons. You may just continue using it.
These cases are not troubles.
Case Explanation
Operation does not start soon.
When ON/OFF button was
pressed soon after
operation was stopped.
When the mode was
reselected.
This is to protect the air conditioner.
You should wait for about 3 minutes.
Hot air does not flow out soon
after the start of heating
operation.
The air conditioner is warming up. You should wait for 1 to 4
minutes.
(The system is designed to start discharging air only after it
has reached a certain temperature.)
The heating operation stops
suddenly and a flowing sound
is heard.
The system is taking away the frost on the outdoor unit.
You should wait for about 3 to 8 minutes.
The outdoor unit emits water or
steam.
In HEAT mode
The frost on the outdoor unit melts into water or steam
when the air conditioner is in defrost operation.
In COOL or DRY mode
Moisture in the air condenses into water on the cool
surface of outdoor unit piping and drips.
Mists come out of the indoor
unit.
This happens when the air in the room is cooled into mist by
the cold air flow during cooling operation.
The indoor unit gives out odour. This happens when smells of the room, furniture, or
cigarettes are absorbed into the unit and discharged with the
air flow.
(If this happens, we recommend you to have the indoor unit
washed by a technician. Consult the service shop where you
bought the air conditioner.)
The outdoor fan rotates while
the air conditioner is not in
operation.
After operation is stopped:
The outdoor fan continues rotating for another 60
seconds for system protection.
While the air conditioner is not in operation:
When the outdoor temperature is very high, the out door
fan starts rotating for system protection.
The operation stopped
suddenly.
(OPERATION lamp is on)
For system protection, the air conditioner may stop
operating on a sudden large voltage fluctuation.
It automatically resumes operation in about 3 minutes.
Instruction Si18-525B
276 Operation Manual
Please check again before calling a repair person.
Check again.
Case Check
The air conditioner does not
operate.
(OPERATION lamp is off)
Hasnt a breaker turned OFF or a fuse blown?
Isnt it a power failure?
Are batteries set in the remote controller?
Is the timer setting correct?
Cooling (Heating) effect is poor. Are the air filters clean?
Is there anything to block the air inlet or the outlet of the
indoor and the outdoor units?
Is the temperature setting appropriate?
Are the windows and doors closed?
Are the air flow rate and the air direction set appropriately?
Is the unit set to the INTELLIGENT EYE mode?
Operation stops suddenly.
(OPERATION lamp flashes.)
Are the air filters clean?
Is there anything to block the air inlet or the outlet of the
indoor and the outdoor units?
Clean the air filters or take all obstacles away and turn the
breaker OFF. Then turn it ON again and try operating the air
conditioner with the remote controller. If the lamp still flashes,
call the service shop where you bought the air conditioner.
Are operation modes all the same for indoor units
connected to outdoor units in the multi system?
If not, set all indoor units to the same operation mode and
confirm that the lamps flash.
Moreover, when the operation mode is in AUTO, set all
indoor unit operation modes to COOL or HEAT for a
moment and check again that the lamps are normal.
If the lamps stop flashing after the above steps, there is no
malfunction.
An abnormal functioning
happens during operation.
The air conditioner may malfunction with lightning or radio
waves. Turn the breaker OFF, turn it ON again and try
operating the air conditioner with the remote controller.
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 277
WARNING
When an abnormality (such as a burning smell) occurs, stop operation and turn the breaker OFF.
Continued operation in an abnormal condition may result in troubles, electric shocks or fire.
Consult the service shop where you bought the air conditioner.
Do not attempt to repair or modify the air conditioner by yourself.
Incorrect work may result in electric shocks or fire.
Consult the service shop where you bought the air conditioner.
If one of the following symptoms takes place, call the service shop immediately.
In certain operating conditions, the inside of the air conditioner may get foul after several seasons of
use, resulting in poor performance. It is recommended to have periodical maintenance by a specialist
aside from regular cleaning by the user. For specialist maintenance, contact the service shop where
you bought the air conditioner.
The maintenance cost must be born by the user.
Call the service shop immediately.
After a power failure
The air conditioner automatically resumes
operation in about 3 minutes. You should just
wait for a while.
Lightning
If lightning may strike the neighbouring area,
stop operation and turn the breaker OFF for
system protection.
We recommend periodical maintenance.
The power cord is abnormally hot or damaged.
An abnormal sound is heard during operation.
The safety breaker, a fuse, or the earth leakage breaker
cuts off the operation frequently.
A switch or a button often fails to work properly.
There is a burning smell.
Water leaks from the indoor unit.
Turn the breaker
OFF and call the
service shop.
Instruction Si18-525B
278 Operation Manual
2.3 Ceiling Mounted Cassette Type
Note: The instruction is for FFQ25/35/50/60B as representative.
[1]
1
3
4 2
TEST
C
hr
hr
TEST
NOT
AVAILABLE
L H
2
10
11
3
1 4 5
6
7
8
14
15 16 17 18
19
20
21
22
12
9
13
a
b
c
d
e
e
f
g
h
i
k
e
f
l
d
j
C
hr
H
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 279
This operation manual is for the following systems
with standard control. Before initiating operation,
contact your Daikin dealer for the operation that
corresponds to your sysem.
Pair system
Multi system
NOTE
If the unit you purchased is controlled by a wire-
less remote controller, also refer to the wireless
remote controllers operation manual.
If your installation has a customized control system,
ask your Daikin dealer for operation that corre-
sponds to your system.
Heat pump type
This system provides cooling, heating, automatic,
program dry, and fan operation modes.
Cooling only type
This system provides cooling, program dry, and
fan operation modes.
PRECAUTIONS FOR GROUP CONTROL
SYSTEM OR TWO REMOTE
CONTROLLER CONTROL SYSTEM
This system provides two other control systems
beside individual control (one remote controller
controls one indoor unit) system. Confirm the fol-
lowing if your unit is of the following control system
type.
Group control system
One remote controller controls up to 16 indoor
units.
All indoor units are equally set.
Two remote controllers control system
Two remote controllers control one indoor unit
(In case of group control system, one group of
indoor units)
The unit is individually operated.
NOTE
Contact your Daikin dealer in case of changing
the combination or setting of group control and
two remote controllers control system.
Names and functions of parts
1. WHAT TO DO BEFORE
OPERATION
Indoor unit
Unit with
remote
controller
Outdoor unit
Indoor unit
Unit with
remote
controller
Unit with
remote
controller
Indoor unit
Outdoor unit
a Indoor unit
b
Outdoor unit
The external appearance of the outdoor
unit varies depending on its capacity
class. The outdoor unit shown in the fig-
ure is for reference to indicate features.
Contact your Daikin Dealer and verify
which outdoor unit you have.
c Remote controller
d Inlet air
e Discharged air
f Air outlet
g Air flow flap (at air outlet)
h Refrigerant piping, connection electric wire
i Drain pipe
j
Air inlet
The built-in air filter removes dust and dirt.
k
Drain pumping out device (built-in)
Drains water removed from the room dur-
ing cooling.
l
Ground wire
Wire to ground from the outdoor unit to pre-
vent electrical shocks.
Refer to figure 2 on page [1]
Instruction Si18-525B
280 Operation Manual
We recommend that you read this instruction man-
ual carefully before use to gain full advantage of the
function of the air conditioner, and to avoid malfunc-
tion due to erroneous handling.
This air conditioner comes under the term appli-
ances not accessible to the general public.
The precautions described below are WARN-
ING and CAUTION. These are very important
precautions concerning safety. Be sure to
observe all of them without fail.
WARNING.. These are the matters with possi-
bilities leading to serious conse-
quences such as death or serious
injury due to erroneous handling.
CAUTION... These are the matters with possi-
bilities leading to injury or mate-
rial damage due to erroneous
handling including probabilities
leading to serious consequences
in some cases.
After reading, keep this manual at a place
where any user can read at any time. Further-
more, make certain that this operation manual
is handed to a new user when he takes over
the operation.
WARNING
Avoid exposure of your body directly to the
cold air for a long time, or avoid excessive
exposure of your body to the cold air.
Otherwise, your physical condition may be deteri-
orated and/or your health may be ruined.
When the air conditioner is in abnormal condi-
tions (smell of something burning, etc), unplug
the power cord from the outlet, and contact the
dealer where you purchased the air condi-
tioner.
Continued operation under such circumstances
may result in a failure, electric shock, and fire.
Ask your dealer for installation of the air condi-
tioner.
Incomplete installation performed by yourself may
result in a failure, a water leakage, electric shock,
and fire.
Ask your dealer for improvement, repair, and
maintenence.
Incomplete improvement, repair, and mainte-
nance may result in a failure, a water leakage,
electric shock, and fire.
Do not insert your finger, a stick, etc., into the
air inlet, outlet, and fan blades.
A fan in high-speed running may result in injury.
For refrigerant leakage, consult your dealer.
When the air conditioner is to be installed in a
small room, it is necessary to take proper mea-
sures so that the amount of any leaked refrigerant
dose not exceed the limiting concentration even
when it leaks. If the refrigerant leaks exceeding
the level of limiting concentration, an oxygen defi-
ciency accident may happen.
For installation of separately sold component
parts, ask a specialist.
Be sure to use the separately sold component
parts designated by our company.
Incomplete installation performed by yourself may
result in a failure, a water leakage, electric shock,
and fire.
Ask your dealer to move and reinstall the air
conditioner.
Incomplete installation may result in a failure, a
water leakage, electric shock, and fire.
The refrigerant in the air conditioner is safe
and normally does not leak. If the refrigerant
leaks inside the room, the contact with a fire of
a burner, a heater or a cooker may result in a
harmful gas.
Do not use the air conditioner until when a service
person confirms to finish repairing the portion
where the refrigerant leaks.
CAUTION
Do not use the air conditioner for other pur-
poses.
Do not use the air conditioner for a special appli-
cation such as the storage of foods, animals and
plants, precision machines, and art objects as
otherwise the deterioration of quality may result.
Do not remove the air outlet of the outdoor
unit.
The fan may get exposed and result in injury.
When the air conditioner is used in combina-
tion with burners or heaters, perform sufficient
ventilation.
Insufficient ventilation may result in an oxygen
deficiency accident.
Check and make sure that foundation blocks
are not damaged after a long use.
If they are left in a damaged condition, the unit
may fall and result in injury.
Neither place a flammable spray bottle near
the air conditioner not perform spraying.
Doing so may result in a fire.
To clean the air conditioner, stop operation,
and unplug the power cord from the outlet.
Otherwise, an electric shock and injury may
result.
Do not operate the air conditioner with a wet
hand.
An electric shock may result.
Do not use any fuse with improper capacity.
The use of piece of wire and whatnot may result
in a failure and fire.
Do not place a burner or heater at a place
directly exposed to the wind from the air condi-
tioner.
Incomplete combustion of the burner or heater
may result.
Do not allow a child to mount on the outdoor
unit or avoid placing any object on it.
Falling or tumbling may result in injury.
2. SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 281
Do not expose animals and plants directly to
the wind from the air conditioner.
Adverse influence to animals and plants may
result.
Do not wash the air conditioner with water.
An electric shock may result.
Do not install the air conditioner at any place
where flammable gas may leak out.
If the gas leaks out and stays around the air con-
ditioner, a fire may break out.
Be sure to install an earth leakage breaker.
Unless it is installed, an electric shock may result.
Be sure the air conditioner is electrically
grounded.
Do not connect the grounding conductor to a gas
pipe, water pipe, lightning arrester, and the
grounding conductor for a telephone.
Imperfect grounding work may result in an electric
shock.
Execute complete drain piping for perfect
drainage.
Incomplete piping may result in a water leakage.
The appliance is not intended for use by young
children or infirm persons without supervision.
Young children should be supervised to ensure
that they do not play with the appliance.
If the temperature or the humidity is beyond the fol-
lowing conditions, safety devices may work and the
air conditioner may not operate, or sometimes,
water may drop from the indoor unit.
COOLING
HEATING
DB: Dry bulb temperature (C)
WB: Wet bulb temperature (C)
The setting temperature range of the remote con-
troller is 16C to 32C.
The numerical value in a parenthesis shows the
operation range of the model for Australia.
Regarding places for installation
Is the air conditioner installed at a well-venti-
lated place where there are no obstacles
around?
Do not use the air conditioner in the following
places.
a. Filled with much mineral oil such as cutting oil
b. Where there is much salt such as a beach
area
c. Where sulfured gas exists such as a hot-spring
resort.
d. Where there are considerable voltage
fluctuations such as a factory or plant
e. Vehicles and vessels
f. Where there is much spray of oil and vapor
such as a cookery, etc.
g. Where there are machines generating
electromagnetic waves.
h. Filled with acid and/or alkaline steam or vapor
Is a snow protection measure taken?
For details, consult your dealer.
Regarding wiring
All wiring must be performed by an authorized
electrician.
To do wiring, ask your dealer. Never do it by
yourself.
Make sure that a separate power supply circuit
is provided for this air conditioner and that all
electrical work is carried out by qualified per-
sonnel according to local laws and regulations.
Pay attention to running noises, too
Are the following places selected?
a. A place that can sufficiently withstand the
weight of the air conditioner with less running
noises and vibrations.
b. A place where the hot wind discharged from
the air outlet of outdoor unit and the running
noises.
Are you sure that there are no obstacles near
the air outlet of the outdoor unit?
Such obstacles may result in declined perfor-
mance and increased running noises.
If abnormal noises occur in use, stop the oper-
ation of the air conditioner, and then consult
your dealer or our service station.
Regarding drainage of drain piping
Is the drain piping executed to perform com-
plete drainage?
If proper drainage is not carried out from the out-
3. OPERATION RANGE
OUTDOOR
UNIT
INDOOR
OUTDOOR
TEMPERA-
TURE
TEMPERA-
TURE
HUMID-
ITY
RS50 60
RKS25 35
50 60
RXS25 35
50 60
D
B
21 to 32
80% or
below
D
B
-10 to 46
(-5)
W
B
14 to 23
3MKS50
4MKS58 75
90
3MXS52
4MXS68 80
D
B
21 to 32
80% or
below
D
B
-10 to 46
W
B
14 to 23
OUTDOOR
UNIT
INDOOR
TEMPERATURE
OUTDOOR
TEMPERATURE
RXS25 35 DB 10 to 30
DB -14 to 24
WB -15 to 20
RXS50 60 DB 10 to 30
DB -14 to 24
WB -15 to 18
3MXS52
4MXS68 80
DB 10 to 30
DB -14 to 21
WB -15 to 15.5
4. INSTALLATION SITE
Instruction Si18-525B
282 Operation Manual
door drain pipes during air-conditioning opera-
tion, chances are that dust and dirt are clogged
in the pipe. This may result in a water leakage
from the indoor unit. Under such circumstances,
stop the operation of the air conditioner, and then
con sult your dealer or our service station.
Operating procedure varies with heat pump type
and cooling only type. Contact your Daikin dealer
to confirm your system type.
To protect the unit, turn on the main power switch
6 hours before operation.
5. NAME AND FUNCTION OF
EACH SWITCH AND DISPLAY
ON THE REMOTE
CONTROLLER
1
ON/OFF BUTTON
Press the button and the system will start.
Press the button again and the system will
stop.
2
OPERATION LAMP (RED)
The lamp lights up during operation.
3
DISPLAY (UNDER CENTRAL-
IZED CONTROL)
When this display shows, the system is
UNDER CENTRALIZED CONTROL.
4
DISPLAY
(VENTILATION/AIR CLEANING)
This display shows that the total heat
exchange and the air cleaning unit are in
operation (These are optional accessories).
5
DISPLAY
(OPERATION MODE)
This display shows the current OPERATION
MODE. For cooling only type, (Auto)
and (Heating) are not installed.
6
DISPLAY TEST (INSPECTION/TEST
OPERATION)
When the INSPECTION/TEST OPERATION
BUTTON is pressed, the display shows the
system mode is in.
7
DISPLAY (PROGRAMMED TIME)
This display shows the PROGRAMMED
TIME of the system start or stop.
8
DISPLAY (SET TEMPERATURE)
This display shows the set temperature.
9
DISPLAY (FAN SPEED)
This display shows the set fan speed.
10
DISPLAY (AIR FLOW FLAP)
Refer to AIR FLOW DIRECTION ADJUST.
Refer to figure 1 on page [1]
11
DISPLAY (TIME TO CLEAN AIR
FIL-TER)
Refer to HOW TO CLEAN THE AIR FILTER.
12
DISPLAY (DEFROST)
Refer to DEFROST OPERATION".
13
NON-FUNCTIONING DISPLAY
If that particular function is not available,
pressing the button may display the words
NOT AVAILABLE for a few seconds.
When running multiple units simultaneously
The NOT AVAILABLE message will only be
appear if none of the indoor units is equipped
with the function. If even one unit is equipped
with the function, the display will not appear.
14
TIMER MODE START/STOP BUTTON
Refer to PROGRAM TIMER OPERATION.
15
TIMER ON/ OFF BUTTON
Refer to PROGRAM TIMER OPERATION
16
INSPECTION/TEST OPERATION BUT-
TON
This button is used only by qualified service
persons for maintenance purposes.
17
PROGRAMMING TIME BUTTON
Use this button for programming START and/
or STOP time.
18
TEMPERATURE SETTING BUTTON
Use this button for SETTING TEMPERA-
TURE.
19
FILTER SIGN RESET BUTTON
Refer to HOW TO CLEAN THE AIR FILTER.
20
FAN SPEED CONTROL BUTTON
Press this button to select the fan speed,
HIGH or LOW, of your choice.
21
OPERATION MODE SELECTOR BUTTON
Press this button to select OPERATION MODE.
22
AIR FLOW DIRECTION ADJUST BUTTON
Refer to AIR FLOW DIRECTION ADJUST.
NOTE
For the sake of explanation, all indications are
shown on the display in figure 1 contrary to
actual running situations.
6. OPERATION PROCEDURE
Refer to figure 1 on page [1]
Si18-525B Instruction
Operation Manual 283
NOTE
The setting temperature range of the remote con-
troller is 16C to 32C.
If the main power supply is turned off during
operation, operation will restart automatically
after the power turns back on again.
Operate in the following order.
Press OPERATION MODE SELECTOR but-
ton several times and select the OPERA-
TION MODE of your choice as follows.
Is there conductivity?
NO
Check the capacitor's
conductivity
Check the fan motor voltage.
(immediately after re-start)
Is it at the rated voltage?
12.7
15.9
9.5
To
Outdoor unit
MODEL
Indoor unit
4D037995G
Piping Diagrams Si18-525B
440 Appendix
1.3.6 Ceiling Mounted Built-in Type
FBQ60/71BV1, FBQ60/71BVL
1.3.7 Ceiling Suspended Type
FHQ35/50/60BUV1B9
Indoor heat exchanger
FHQ35BUV1B
FHQ35BVV1B
FCQ35BVE
FCQ35C7VEB
FHQ50, 60BUV1B
FHQ50, 60BVV1B
FCQ50, 60BVE
FBQ60BV1
FBQ60BVL
FCQ50, 60C7VEB
FUQ71, 100, 125BUV1B
FUQ71, 100, 125BVV1B
FHQ71, 100, 125BUV1B
FHQ71, 100, 125BVV1B
FAQ71, 100BUV1B
FAQ71, 100BVV1B
FXUQ70, 100, 125MV1
FHQ71, 100, 125BAV3B
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140DV3B
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140DAV3B
FCQ71BVE
FBQ71BV1
FBQ71BVL
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140C7VEB
FCQH71, 100, 125, 140C7VEB
Field piping
Field piping
C1220T-0
C1220T-0
6.4
6.4
9.5
12.7
15.9
9.5
To
Outdoor unit
MODEL
Indoor unit
4D037995G
Indoor heat exchanger
FHQ35BUV1B
FHQ35BVV1B
FCQ35BVE
FCQ35C7VEB
FHQ50, 60BUV1B
FHQ50, 60BVV1B
FCQ50, 60BVE
FBQ60BV1
FBQ60BVL
FCQ50, 60C7VEB
FUQ71, 100, 125BUV1B
FUQ71, 100, 125BVV1B
FHQ71, 100, 125BUV1B
FHQ71, 100, 125BVV1B
FAQ71, 100BUV1B
FAQ71, 100BVV1B
FXUQ70, 100, 125MV1
FHQ71, 100, 125BAV3B
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140DV3B
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140DAV3B
FCQ71BVE
FBQ71BV1
FBQ71BVL
FCQ71, 100, 125, 140C7VEB
FCQH71, 100, 125, 140C7VEB
Field piping
Field piping
C1220T-0
C1220T-0
6.4
6.4
9.5
12.7
15.9
9.5
To
Outdoor unit
MODEL
Indoor unit
4D037995G
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 441
2. Wiring Diagrams
2.1 Outdoor Units
RMKS112/140/160DVM, RMKS112/140/160DV1A
POWER SUPPLY
VM
V1A
220-230V~50/60Hz
220-240V~50Hz
THE POSITION OF
COMPRESSOR
TERMINAL
OF WIRE
THE ENTRANCE
L1R
A2P
A3P
N
L
U
YLW
V1T
N
P2
P1
P3
P4
+
-
W
V2R
V
E1
+ C2
Z1C
K1M
X1M
RED
LB
LC
RED
LA
M1C
+
+
U
U
L
RED
N
V
V
3~
MS
R1
+
+
WHT
Z1F
GRN/YLW
C3
C1
W
W
K2R
F1U
BLU
NB
BLU
R2
BLU
NC
NA
N
-
N
-
BRN
N=5
V1R
M1F
X1A
Z2C
WHT(RED MARKING)
3~
MS
PS
X206A
RED
RED
RED
X60A
M2F
Z3C
3~
MS
S1PH
P<
X207A
HAP
WHT
WHT
WHT
WHT
X205A
RED
BLU
X1A
A1P
X25A
1
Y1S
R3T
t
X2A
X1M
A
X34A
Y2S
K
1
R
C/H SELECTOR
X3A
B
K
2
R
1
R2T
t
C
R4T
TO BP UNIT
F1
t
E1HC
F2
X6A
BP UNIT
X37A
(F1)(F2)
R5T
TO OUT/D UNIT
t
NOTE)8
F1
HAP
X22A
BS1
K
5
R
H1P
F2
BS2
OFF
OFF
H2P
ON
ON
H3P
t
BS3
1
1
H4P
T1R
DS2
DS1
2
2
H5P
3
3
BS4
H6P
4
4
H7P
BS5
X23A
FRONT
A1P
X26A
X45A
X46A
X28A
X44A
X1M
NOTE)4
A3P
X24A
X1M
A
t
S1NPL
S1NPH
6
6
VIEW A
L1R
Y2E
R1T
Y1E
A2P
M
M
A2P
A3P
HAP
K2R
HAP
K2R
K5R
R2
M2F
E1HC
R2T
R4T
R5T
R3T
BS1~5
Y2E
Y2S
A1P
F1U
H1P~7P
K1M
K1R
L1R
V1T
PS
R1
S1NPL
S1PH
V1R, V2R
M1F
M1C
R1T
S1NPH
T1R
Y1E
Y1S
Z1C~3C
Z1F
X1M
X1M
DS1,2
C1,2,3
L-RED
POWER MODULE (A2P)
CRANKCASE HEATER
PUSH BUTTON SWITCH
REACTOR
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (COMPRESSOR)
PRESSURES WITCH (HIGH)
PRESSURE SENSOR (LOW)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-ORANGE)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN) (A2P)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN) (A1P)
TRANSFORMER(220-240V/24V)
PRESSURE SENSOR (HIGH)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (NOISE FILTER)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (MAIN)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (SUB COOL)
FUSE( 6.3A/250V)
MAGNETIC RELAY (K1M)
MAGNETIC CONTACTOR (M1C)
CAPACITOR
DIP SWITCH
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (INV)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (MAIN)
NOISE FILTER (WITH SURGE ABSORBER)
THERMISTOR (SUCTION)
[H2P]PREPARE, TEST ------------ FLICKERING
TERMINAL STRIP (CONTROL) (A1P)
TERMINAL STRIP (POWER SUPPLY)
SOLENOID VALVE (RECEIVER GAS PURGE)
SOLENOID VALVE (HOT GAS)
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLY
IGBT (A2P)
NOISE FILTER (FERRITE CORE)
MAGNETIC RELAY (E1HC)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y2S)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y1S)
RESISTOR (CURRENT SENSOR)
RESISTOR (CURRENT LIMITING)
THERMISTOR (AIR)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC. OUTLET)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC. DEICER)
THERMISTOR (M1C DISCHARGE)
(MODE, SET, RETURN, TEST, RESET)
MALFUNCTION DETECTION --- LIGHT UP
T
N-BLU
3D048943
NOTES)1.THIS WIRING DIAGRAM IS APPLIED ONLY TO THE OUTDOOR UNIT.
2. :FIELD WIRING.
3. :TERMINAL STRIP , :MOVABLE CONNECTOR :FIXED CONNECTOR :TERMINAL
:PROTECTIVE EARTH (SCREW) :NOISELESS EARTH
4.WHEN USING THE OPTION ADAPTOR, REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL.
5.REFER TO"OPERATION CAUTION LABEL"(ON BACK OF FRONT PLATE), HOW TO USE BS1~BS5 AND DS12 SWITCH.
6.WHEN OPERATING, DONT SHORT CIRCUIT FOR PROTECTION DEVICE. (S1PH)
7.COLORS BLU:BLUE BRN:BROWN GRN:GREEN RED:RED WHT:WHITE YLW:YELLOW.
8.REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL, FOR CONNECTION WIRING TO BP UNIT-OUTDOOR TRANSMISSION F1 F2.
Wiring Diagrams Si18-525B
442 Appendix
RMXS112/140/160DVM, RMXS112/140/160DV1A, RMXS112/140/160DVLT
POWER SUPPLY
V1A
220-240V~50Hz
VLT
220~60Hz
VM
220-230V~50/60Hz
THE POSITION OF
COMPRESSOR
TERMINAL
THE ENTRANCE
OF WIRE
L1R
A2P
A3P
N
L
U
YLW
V1T
N
P2
P1
P3
P4
+
-
W
V2R
V
E1
+ C2
Z1C
K1M
X1M
RED
LB
LC
RED
LA
M1C
+
+
U
U
L
RED
N
V
V
3~
MS
R1
+
+
WHT
Z1F
GRN
C3
C1
W
W
K2R
F1U
BLU
NB
BLU
R2
BLU
NC
/
NA
YLW
N
-
N
-
BRN
N=5
V1R
M1F
X1A
Z2C
WHT(RED MARKING)
3~
MS
PS
X206A
RED
RED
RED
X60A
M2F
Z3C
3~
MS
S1PH
P<
X207A
HAP
WHT
WHT
WHT
WHT
X205A
RED
BLU
NOTES)1.THIS WIRING DIAGRAM IS APPLIED ONLY TO THE OUTDOOR UNIT.
2. :FIELD WIRING.
3. :TERMINAL STRIP , :MOVABLE CONNECTOR :FIXED CONNECTOR :TERMINAL
:PROTECTIVE EARTH (SCREW) :NOISELESS EARTH
4.WHEN USING THE OPTION ADAPTOR, REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL.
5.REFER TO"OPERATION CAUTION LABEL"(ON BACK OF FRONT PLATE), HOW TO USE BS1~BS5 AND DS12 SWITCH.
6.WHEN OPERATING, DONT SHORT CIRCUIT FOR PROTECTION DEVICE. (S1PH)
7.COLORS BLU:BLUE BRN:BROWN GRN:GREEN RED:RED WHT:WHITE YLW:YELLOW.
8.REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL, FOR CONNECTION WIRING TO BP UNIT-OUTDOOR TRANSMISSION F1 F2.
X1A
A1P
X25A
C/H SELECTOR(OPTIONAL ACCESSORY)
1
Y1S
R3T
t
COOL
X2A
X1M
A
Y2S
X34A
K
1
R
C/H SELECTOR
X3A
S2S
HEAT
B
K
2
R
COOL
HEAT
1
R2T
t
C
Y3S
FAN
S1S
TO BP UNIT
X5A
R4T
F1
t
K
4
R
E1HC
F2
X6A
BP UNIT
X37A
(F1)(F2)
R5T
TO OUT/D UNIT
t
NOTE)8
F1
HAP
X22A
BS1
K
5
R
H1P
F2
BS2
OFF
OFF
H2P
ON
ON
H3P
t
BS3
1
1
H4P
T1R
DS2
DS1
2
2
H5P
3
3
BS4
H6P
4
4
H7P
BS5
X23A
FRONT
A1P
X26A
X45A
X46A
X28A
X44A
X1M
NOTE)4
A3P
X24A
X1M
A
t
S1NPL
S1NPH
6
6
VIEW A
L1R
Y2E
R1T
Y1E
A2P
M
M
A2P
A3P
HAP
HAP
K2R
K4R
K2R
K5R
R2
M2F
E1HC
R2T
R4T
R3T
R5T
BS1~5
Y2E
Y2S
Y3S
S2S
A1P
F1U
H1P~7P
K1M
K1R
L1R
PS
V1T
R1
S1PH
S1NPL
V1R, V2R
M1F
M1C
R1T
T1R
Y1E
Z1F
Z1C~3C
Y1S
S1S
S1NPH
X1M
X1M
DS1,2
C1,2,3
L-RED
C/H SELECTOR (KRC19-26A)
POWER MODULE (A2P)
CRANKCASE HEATER
SELECTOR SWITCH (COOL/HEAT)
SELECTOR SWITCH (FAN/COOLHEAT)
PUSH BUTTON SWITCH
REACTOR
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (COMPRESSOR)
PRESSURE SWITCH (HIGH)
PRESSURE SENSOR (LOW)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-ORANGE)
PILOT LAMP (SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN)(A1P)
PILOT LAMP (SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN)(A2P)
PRESSURE SENSOR (HIGH)
TRANSFORMER (220-240V/24V)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (NOISE FILTER)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (SUBCOOL)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (MAIN)
FUSE( 6.3A/250V)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (INV)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (MAIN)
DIP SWITCH
MAGNETIC CONTACTOR (M1C)
MAGNETIC RELAY (K1M)
CAPACITOR
NOISE FILTER (WITH SURGE ABSORBER)
THERMISTOR (SUCTION)
[H2P] PREPARE,TEST ------------ FLICKERING
TERMINAL STRIP (CONTROL) (A1P)
TERMINAL STRIP (POWER SUPPLY)
SOLENOID VALVE (HOT GAS)
SOLENOID VALVE (RECEIVER GAS PURGE)
SOLENOID VALVE (4 WAY VALVE)
IGBT (A2P)
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLY
NOISE FILTER (FERRITE CORE)
MAGNETIC RELAY (E1HC)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y3S)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y2S)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y1S)
RESISTOR (CURRENT LIMITING)
RESISTOR (CURRENT SENSOR)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC. OUTLET)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC. DEICER)
THERMISTOR (M1C DISCHARGE)
THERMISTOR (AIR)
(MODE, SET, RETURN, TEST, RESET)
MALFUNCTION DETECTION --- LIGHT UP
T
3D048789
N-BLU
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 443
RMKD112/140/160DVM
POWER SUPPLY
220-230 ~ 50/60Hz
L1R
L
N
A2P
A3P
U
V1T
N
P2
P1
P3
P4
W
V2R
V
E1
X201A
C2
Z1C
K1M
X1M
LA
LB
LC
M1C
U
L N
V
3 ~
MS
3 ~
MS
3 ~
MS
R1
Z1F
C3
C1
W
K2R
F1U
NB
R2
NC
NA
-
N
N=5
V1R
M1F
X1A
Z2C
PS
X206A
X60A
M2F
Z3C
S1PH
P<
X207A
HAP
X205A
X1A
A1P
X25A
1
R3T
t
Y1S
X2A
X1M
A
X34A
K
1
R
C/H SELECTOR
Y2S
X3A
B
K
2
R
1
R2T
t
C
R4T
TO BP UNIT
F1
t
E1HC
F2
X6A
BP UNIT
(F1)(F2)
X37A
R5T
TO OUT/D UNIT
t
NOTE)8
X22A
F1
HAP
BS1
K
5
R
H1P
F2
BS2
OFF
OFF
H2P
ON
ON
H3P
t
BS3
1
H4P
T1R
DS2
DS1
2
H5P
3
BS4
H6P
4
H7P
BS5
X23A
FRONT
A1P
X45A
X46A
X26A
X28A
X44A
NOTE)4
A3P
X1M
X1M
X24A
A
t
S1NPL
S1NPH
6
6
VIEW A
L1R
Y2E
R1T
Y1E
A2P
M
M
A3P
A2P
HAP
K2R
K2R
HAP
K5R
R2
M2F
E1HC
R3T
R2T
R5T
R4T
BS1 ~ 5
Y2E
Y2S
A1P
F1U
H1P ~ 7P
K1M
K1R
L1R
PS
V1T
R1
S1PH
S1NPL
V1R,V2R
M1C
M1F
R1T
S1NPH
T1R
Y1E
Z1C ~ 3C
Z1F
Y1S
X1M
X1M
DS1, 2
C1, 2, 3
L-RED
POWER MODULE (A2P)
CRANKCASE HEATER
PUSH BUTTON SWITCH
(MODE, SET, RETURN, TEST, RESET)
REACTOR
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (FAN)
MOTOR (COMPRESSOR)
PRESSURE SWITCH (HIGH)
PRESSURE SENSOR (LOW)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN)(A2P)
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-GREEN)(A1P)
TRANSFORMER (220-230V/20V)
PRESSURE SENSOR (HIGH)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (NOISEFILTER)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (SUBCOOL)
ELECTRONIC EXPANSION VALVE (MAIN)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (INV)
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD (MAIN)
DIP SWITCH
MAGNETIC RELAY (K1M)
MAGNETIC CONTACTOR (M1C)
CAPACITOR
NOISE FILTER (WITH SURGE ABSORBER)
THERMISTOR (SUCTION)
TERMINAL STRIP (CONTROL)(A1P)
TERMINAL STRIP (POWER SUPPLY)
SOLENOID VALVE (RECEIVER GAS PURGE)
SOLENOID VALVE (HOT GAS)
IGBT (A2P)
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLY
NOISE FILTER (FERRITE CORE)
MAGNETIC RELAY (E1HC)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y2S)
MAGNETIC RELAY (Y1S)
RESISTOR (CURRENT SENSOR)
RESISTOR (CURRENT LIMITING)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC.OUTLET)
THERMISTOR (HEAT EXC.DEICER)
THERMISTOR (M1C DISCHARGE)
THERMISTOR (AIR)
N-BLU
FUSE( 6.3A/250V) T
PILOT LAMP(SERVICE MONITOR-ORANGE)
[H2P]PREPARE,TEST ----------- FLICKERING
MALFUNCTION DETECTION --- LIGHT UP
1 2 3 4
RED
GRN/YLW
BLU
RED BLU
YLW
RED WHT BLU BRN
WHT(RED MARKING)
RED
RED
RED
WHT
WHT
WHT
WHT
RED
BLU
NOTES)
1. THIS WIRING DIAGRAM IS APPLIED ONLY TO THE OUTDOOR UNIT.
2. : FIELD WIRING.
3. : TERMINAL STRIP , : MOVABLE CONNECTOR : FIXED CONNECTOR : TERMINAL : PROTECTIVE EARTH (SCREW) : NOISELESS EARTH
4. WHEN USING THE OPTION ADAPTOR, REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL.
5. REFER TO "OPERATION CAUTION LABEL "(ON BACK OF FRONT PLATE), HOW TO USE BS1 ~ BS5 AND DS1 2 SWITCH.
6. WHEN OPERATING, DONT SHORT CIRCUIT FOR PROTECTION DEVICE. (S1PH)
7. COLORS BLU : BLUE BRN : BROWN GRN : GREEN RED : RED WHT : WHITE YLW : YELLOW.
8. REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL, FOR CONNECTION WIRING TO BP UNIT-OUTDOOR TRANSMISSION F1 F2."
U V W N
THE POSITION OF
COMPRESSOR
TERMINAL
THE ENTRANCE
OF WIRE
+
-
+
+
+
+
+
-
3D049709A
Wiring Diagrams Si18-525B
444 Appendix
2.2 BP Units
BPMKS967A2, BPMKD967A2
BPMKS967A3, BPMKD967A3
ROOM B
ROOM A
INDOOR
INDOOR
FIELD WIRING
3
3
2
2
1
1
PCB
OFF
X3M
X4M
3
2
3
2
1
1
3
2
4
1
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
DS2
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
H3P
H4P
H2P
H5P
H1P
E1
LEDA
LED2
LED4
LED3
LED1
(DLA)
R1T
t
(DGA)
R2T
3.15A
F2U
t
(DLB)
R3T
t
(DGB)
R4T
T201R
t
(WHT)
X90A
12
1
(WHT)
(RED)
(BLU)
X22A
X20A
X21A
X6M
X1M
6
6
6
1
1
1
L2
F2
N2
L1
F1
N1
Y3E
Y2E
Y1E
M
M
M
L1
N1
FOR TRANSMISSION
TO OUTDOOR (F1F2)
OR OTHER BP UNIT
ROOM A
ROOM B
BYPASS
TO OTHER BP UNIT
POWER SUPPLY
220V-230V~60Hz
220V-240V~50Hz
N
L
GRN/YLW
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
YLW
YLW
YLW
RED
BLU
RED
BLU
RED
BLU
WHT
WHT
WHT
BRW
BRW
BRW
ORG
ORG
ORG
X20A~X22A, X90A : CONNECTOR H1P~H5P : PILOT LAMP T201R : TRANSFORMAR
PCB : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD R1T~R4T : THERMISTOR X1M, X3M, X4M, X6M : TERMINAL STRIP
F2U : FUSE DS2 : DIP SWITCH Y1E~Y3E : MOTOR OPERATED VALVE COIL
3D048438
ROOM A
ROOM B
ROOM C
INDOOR
INDOOR
INDOOR
FIELD WIRING
3
3
3
2
2
2
1
1
1
PCB
OFF
X3M
X4M
X5M
3
3
2
2
3
2
1
1
1
2
3
4
1
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
DS2
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
H3P
H4P
H2P
H5P
H1P
E1
LEDA
LED2
LED3
LED4
LED1
(DLA)
R1T
t
(DGA)
R2T
3.15A
F2U
t
(DLB)
R3T
t
(DGB)
R4T
T201R
t
(DLC)
R5T
t
(DGC)
R6T
t
(WHT)
X90A
12
1
(WHT)
(YLW)
(RED)
(BLU)
X22A
X23A
X20A
X21A
X6M
X1M
6
6
6
6
1
1
1
1
L2
F2
N2
L1
F1
N1
Y3E
Y2E
Y4E
Y1E
M
M
M
M
L1
N1
FOR TRANSMISSION
ROOM C
ROOM A
ROOM B
BYPASS
OR OTHER BP UNIT
TO OUTDOOR (F1F2)
TO OTHER BP UNIT
POWER SUPPLY
220V-230V~60Hz
220V-240V~50Hz
N
L
GRN/YLW
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
YLW
YLW
YLW
YLW
BLU
RED
RED
BLU
BLU
RED
RED
BLU
WHT
WHT
WHT
WHT
BRW
BRW
BRW
BRW
ORG
ORG
ORG
ORG
X20A~X23A, X90A : CONNECTOR H1P~H5P : PILOT LAMP T201R : TRANSFORMAR
PCB : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD R1T~R6T : THERMISTOR X1M, X3M~X6M : TERMINAL STRIP
F2U : FUSE DS2 : DIP SWITCH Y1E~Y4E : MOTOR OPERATED VALVE COIL
3D048288
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 445
BPMKS967A2B
BPMKS967A3B
ROOM B
ROOM A
INDOOR
INDOOR
FIELD WIRING
3
3
2
2
1
1
PCB
OFF
X3M
X4M
3
2
3
2
1
1
3
2
4
1
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
DS2
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
H3P
H4P
H2P
H5P
H1P
E1
LEDA
LED2
LED4
LED3
LED1
(DLA)
R1T
t
(DGA)
R2T
3.15A
F2U
t
(DLB)
R3T
t
(DGB)
R4T
T201R
t
(WHT)
X90A
12
1
(WHT)
(RED)
(BLU)
X22A
X20A
X21A
X6M
X1M
6
6
6
1
1
1
L2
F2
N2
L1
F1
N1
Y3E
Y2E
Y1E
M
M
M
L1
N1
FOR TRANSMISSION
TO OUTDOOR (F1F2)
OR OTHER BP UNIT
ROOM A
ROOM B
BYPASS
TO OTHER BP UNIT
N
L
POWER SUPPLY
230V~50Hz
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
YLW
YLW
YLW
RED
BLU
RED
BLU
RED
BLU
WHT
WHT
WHT
BRW
BRW
BRW
ORG
ORG
ORG
X20A~X22A, X90A : CONNECTOR H1P~H5P : PILOT LAMP T201R : TRANSFORMAR
PCB : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD R1T~R4T : THERMISTOR X1M, X3M, X4M, X6M : TERMINAL STRIP
F2U : FUSE DS2 : DIP SWITCH Y1E~Y3E : MOTOR OPERATED VALVE COIL
GRN/YLW
3D048565B
ROOM B
ROOM A
ROOM C
INDOOR
INDOOR
INDOOR
FIELD WIRING
3
3
3
2
2
2
1
1
1
PCB
OFF
X3M
X4M
X5M
2
3
2
2
3
3
1
1
1
3
4
2
1
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
DS2
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
H2P
H3P
H4P
H5P
H1P
E1
LEDA
LED2
LED4
LED3
LED1
(DLA)
R1T
t
(DGA)
R2T
3.15A
F2U
t
(DLB)
R3T
t
(DGB)
R4T
T201R
t
(DLC)
R5T
t
(DGC)
R6T
t
(WHT)
X90A
12
1
(WHT)
(YLW)
(RED)
(BLU)
X22A
X23A
X20A
X21A
X6M
X1M
6
6
6
6
1
1
1
1
L2
F2
N2
L1
F1
N1
Y4E
Y3E
Y2E
Y1E
M
M
M
M
L1
N1
FOR TRANSMISSION
TO OUTDOOR (F1F2)
OR OTHER BP UNIT
ROOM C
ROOM B
ROOM A
BYPASS
TO OTHER BP UNIT
L
N
POWER SUPPLY
230V~50Hz
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
K
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
B
L
U
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
Y
L
W
YLW
YLW
YLW
YLW
BLU
RED
RED
RED
BLU
BLU
RED
BLU
WHT
WHT
WHT
WHT
BRW
BRW
BRW
BRW
ORG
ORG
ORG
ORG
X20A~X23A, X90A : CONNECTOR H1P~H5P : PILOT LAMP T201R : TRANSFORMAR
PCB : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD R1T~R6T : THERMISTOR X1M, X3M~X6M : TERMINAL STRIP
F2U : FUSE DS2 : DIP SWITCH Y1E~Y4E : MOTOR OPERATED VALVE COIL
GRN/YLW
3D048566A
Wiring Diagrams Si18-525B
446 Appendix
2.3 Indoor Units
2.3.1 Wall Mounted Type
FTKS25/35DVM, FTK(X)S20/25/35DVMA
FTXS20/25/35DVMT
WIRELESS
REMOTE
CONTROLLER
PCB3
PCB4
INTELLIGENT EYE
SENSOR
LED3
LED2
H2P
H3P
LED1
H1P
S1W
R1T
t
S27
S36
S26
PCB2
S35
S21
HA
SIGNAL
RECEIVER
PCB1
S29
S28
R2T
S32
t
~
RECTIFIER
1
M1S
M
S6
~
5
V1
TRANSMISSION
CIRCUIT
7
1
3.15A
S1
F1U
H2
H3
H1
INDOOR
M1F
FG
M
X1M
3
2
1
FIELD WIRING.
3
2
1
OUTDOOR
R
E
D
O
R
G
Y
L
W
P
N
K
B
L
U
WHT
BRN
RED
BLU
ORG
GRN
WHT
RED
/
BLK
YLW
FG : FRAME GROUND
F1U : FUSE
H1P~H3P : PILOT LAMP
M1F : FAN MOTOR
M1S : SWING MOTOR
PCB1~PCB4 : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
R1T, R2T : THERMISTOR.
S1~S38 : CONNECTOR
S1W : OPERATION SWITCH
X1M : TERMINAL STRIP
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
ON AGAIN.
CAUTION
3D046453B
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 447
FTKS50BVMB, FTK(X)S50BVMA8, FTXS50DVMT
FTKS60/71BVMB, FTK(X)S60/71BVMA8, FTXS60/71DVMT
3D038065G
CONTROLLER
WIRELESS
REMOTE
PCB4
PCB3
PCB5
INTELLIGENT EYE
LED1
H1P
R1T
SENSOR
t
S37
S38
LED2
H2P
LED3
H3P
PCB2
S27
S36
S1W
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
S26
S35
S21
S29
S28
PCB1
R2T
S32
t
~
RECTIFIER
1
R
E
D
M1S
M
S6
O
R
G
Y
L
W
~
P
N
K
5
B
L
U
1
TRANSMISSION
B
R
N
R
E
D
CIRCUIT
M2S
S8
M
O
R
G
Y
L
W
7
1
3.15A
S1
P
N
K
6
Fu
B
L
U
WHT
BRN
RED
BLU
ORG
H2
H3
H1
INDOOR
M1F
FG
M
GRN
FG
Fu
H1~H3
H1P~H3P
M1F
M1S, M2S
PCB1~PCB5
R1T, R2T
S1~S38
S1W
X1M
WHT
RED
/
BLK
YLW
X1M
3
2
1
: SWING MOTOR
: THERMISTOR
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
ON AGAIN.
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
FIELD WIRING.
CAUTION
3
2
1
OUTDOOR
: FRAME GROUND
: FUSE
: HARNESS
: PILOT LAMP
: FAN MOTOR
: PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
: CONNECTOR
: OPERATION SWITCH
: TERMINAL STRIP
CONTROLLER
WIRELESS
REMOTE
PCB4
PCB3
PCB5
INTELLIGENT EYE
LED1
H1P
R1T
SENSOR
t
S37
S38
LED2
H2P
LED3
H3P
PCB2
S27
S36
S1W
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
S26
S35
S21
S29
S28
PCB1
R2T
S32
t
~
RECTIFIER
1
R
E
D
M1S
M
S6
O
R
G
Y
L
W
~
P
N
K
5
B
L
U
1
TRANSMISSION
B
R
N
R
E
D
CIRCUIT
M2S
S8
M
O
R
G
Y
L
W
7
1
3.15A
S1
P
N
K
6
Fu
B
L
U
WHT
BRN
RED
BLU
ORG
H2
H3
H1
INDOOR
FG
M1F
M
GRN
R1T, R2T
M1S, M2S
PCB1~ PCB5
WHT
RED
/
BLK
Fu
M1F
H1 ~ H3
S1 ~ S38
H1P ~ H3P
FG
YLW
X1M
S1W
X1M
3
2
1
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
ON AGAIN.
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
FIELD WIRING.
CAUTION
3
2
1
OUTDOOR
: FRAME GROUND
: FUSE
: HARNESS
: PILOT LAMP
: FAN MOTOR
: SWING MOTOR
: PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
: THERMISTOR
: CONNECTOR
: OPERATION SWITCH
: TERMINAL STRIP
3D038530N
Wiring Diagrams Si18-525B
448 Appendix
FTK50/60/71AZVMB, FTK50/60/71AVM
FTKD25/35DVM
SIGNAL
RECEIVER
LED
PCB3
H1P
PCB4
S1W
LED
H2P
WIRELESS
REMOTE
CONTROLLER
LED
H3P
R1T
S31
t
S27
S25 S24
S26
S32
R2T
t
S21
HA
PCB1
S37
S8
S6
S36
PCB2
M
M
M2S
M1S
TRANSMISSION
CIRCUIT
S201
3.15A
Fu
M1F
M
H2
H3
FG
H1
indoor
GRN
WHT
BLK
RED
YLW
/
X1M
3
2
1
FIELD WIRING.
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
ON AGAIN.
CAUTION
1
3
2
outdoor
FG : FRAME GROUND
Fu : FUSE
H1P~H3P : PILOT LAMP
M1F : FAN MOTOR
M1S, M2S : SWING MOTOR
PCB1~PCB4 : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
R1T~R2T : THERMISTOR
S1~S201 : CONNECTOR
S1W : OPERATION SWITCH
X1M : TERMINAL STRIP
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
3D033597
WIRELESS
REMOTE
CONTROLLER
PCB3
PCB4
INTELLIGENT EYE
SENSOR
LED3
LED2
H2P
H3P
LED1
H1P
S1W
R1T
t
S27
S36
S26
PCB2
S35
S21
HA
SIGNAL
RECEIVER
PCB1
S29
S28
R2T
S32
t
1
M1S
M
S6
S7
S1
5
BLU
PPL
BLK
WHT
C70
RED
GRY
TRANSMISSION
CIRCUIT
V1
t
M
INDOOR
140C
M1F
3.15A
F1U
H3
H2
H1
X1M
3
2
1
FIELD WIRING.
3
2
1
OUTDOOR
R
E
D
O
R
G
Y
L
W
P
N
K
B
L
U
GRN
WHT
RED
/
BLK
YLW
C70 : RUNNING CAPACITOR
F1U : FUSE
H1P~H3P : PILOT LAMP
M1F : FAN MOTOR
M1S : SWING MOTOR
PCB1~PCB4 : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
R1T, R2T : THERMISTOR
S1~S38 : CONNECTOR
S1W : OPERATION SWITCH
X1M : TERMINAL STRIP
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
ON AGAIN.
CAUTION
3D046468A
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 449
FTKD50/60/71FVM
CONTROLLER
WIRELESS
REMOTE
PCB4
PCB3
PCB5
INTELLIGENT EYE
LED1
H1P
R1T
SENSOR
t
S37
S38
LED2
H2P
LED3
H3P
PCB2
S27
S36
S1W
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
S26
S35
S21
S29
S28
PCB1
R2T
S32
t
~
RECTIFIER
1
R
E
D
M1S
M
S6
O
R
G
Y
L
W
~
P
N
K
5
B
L
U
1
TRANSMISSION
B
R
N
R
E
D
CIRCUIT
M2S
S8
M
O
R
G
Y
L
W
7
1
3.15A
S1
P
N
K
6
Fu
B
L
U
WHT
BRN
RED
BLU
ORG
H2
H3
H1
INDOOR
FG
M1F
M
GRN
R1T, R2T
M1S, M2S
PCB1~ PCB5
WHT
RED
/
BLK
Fu
M1F
H1 ~ H3
S1 ~ S38
H1P ~ H3P
FG
YLW
X1M
S1W
X1M
3
2
1
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
ON AGAIN.
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
FIELD WIRING.
CAUTION
3
2
1
OUTDOOR
: FRAME GROUND
: FUSE
: HARNESS
: PILOT LAMP
: FAN MOTOR
: SWING MOTOR
: PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
: THERMISTOR
: CONNECTOR
: OPERATION SWITCH
: TERMINAL STRIP
3D038530N
Wiring Diagrams Si18-525B
450 Appendix
2.3.2 Duct Connected Type
FDKS25/35CVMB, CDKS50/60CVMB, CDK(X)S25/35/50/60CVMA, CDKD25/35/50/60CVM, CDKD25/35EAVM
CDXS25/35/50/60DVMT
PCB2
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
LED
H1P
CONTROLLER
REMOTE
WIRELESS
LED
H2P
S1W
LED
H3P
2
RTH1
R1T
t
10
1
S1
1
C1
BRN
F1U :
S26
2
PCB1
S32
R2T
t
1
10
:
:
BRN
S21
1
FUSE
(
CAPACITOR(M1F)
PROTECTIVE EARTH
TERMINAL FOR
CENTRALIZED CONTROL
indoor
3
1
S7
BLU
GRY
PPL
S1
)
RED
6
V1TR
1
M1F
~
M
3
BLK
Q1M
130C
1
WHT
YLW
TRANSMISSION
CIRCUIT
C1
3.15A
F1U
Q1M
M1F
V1TR
S1W
X1M
Z1C
H1P ~ H3P
R1T ~ R2T
PCB1 ~ PCB2
S1 ~ S32, RTH1
GND
H2
H3
H1
: FAN MOTOR
: PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
: NOISE FILTER(FERRITE CORE)
: PHASE CONTROL CIRCUIT
: TERMINAL BLOCK
: OPERATION SWITCH
: THERMAL PROTECTOR (M1F EMBEDDED)
: THERMISTOR
: PILOT LAMP
Z1C
N=2
: CONNECTOR
GRN
GRN
WHT
/
/
BLK
RED
YLW
YLW
X1M
2
3
1
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
ON AGAIN.
CAUTION
FIELD WIRING.
2
3
1
outdoor
3D045012K
Si18-525B Wiring Diagrams
Appendix 451
2.3.3 Floor / Ceiling Suspended Dual Type
FLXS25/35/50/60BVMA
2.3.4 Floor Standing Type
FVXS35/50BVMA
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
LED
H1P
CONTROLLER
WIRELESS
PCB3
LED
H2P
REMOTE
PCB4
S1W
LED
H3P
R1T
S31
t
S27
S25 S24
S26
S32
R2T
t
PCB1
S21
HA
M
S6
M1S
S37
S7
X21A
S36
H4
100
1~
M
t
H5
C70
C
M1F
H6
X11A
PCB2
TRANSMISSION
CIRCUIT
H1P~H3P : PILOT LAMP
M1F : FAN MOTOR
FU : FUSE
M1S : SWING MOTOR
C70 : RUNNING CAPACITOR
3.15A
Fu
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
H2
H3
H1
indoor
GRN
WHT
RED
BLK
/
YLW
X1M
2
3
1
NOTE THAT OPERATION WILL
THE MAIN POWER SUPPLY IS
TURNED OFF AND THEN BACK
RESTART AUTOMATICALLY IF
ON AGAIN.
S1W : OPERATION SWITCH(SW7)
S6~S37, X11A, X21A : CONNECTOR
PCB1~PCB4 : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
R1T~R2T : THERMISTOR
X1M : TERMINAL STRIP
CAUTION
FIELD WIRING.
2
3
1
3D033909E
outdoor
CONTROLLER
WIRELESS
REMOTE
indoor
H1P
S1W
S2W(4)
S4W
M2S
H2P
M1S
PCB4
PCB3
H3P
RECEIVER
SIGNAL
M
M
L1S
S24
S42
S26
S41
S23
S25
S6
PCB2
S31
R1T
S21
TRANSMISSION
S32
R2T
CIRCUIT
HA
3.15A
FU
S7
S302
S203
S201
S301
H3
H2
H1
S44
S43
S8
S204
S202
PCB1
M
M
(LOWER FAN MOTOR)
(UPPER FAN MOTOR)
M2F
M1F
FG
GRN
WHT
BLK
RED
/
S4W : AIR OUTLET SELECTION SWITCH
S6~S302 : CONNECTOR
FU : FUSE
M2S : LOWER AIR OUTLET MOTOR
S1W : OPERATION SWITCH
PCB1~PCB4 : PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
S2W(4) : UPWARD AIR FLOW LIMIT SWITCH
M1S : SWING MOTOR
L1S : LIMIT SWITCH
X1M : TERMINAL STRIP
R1T, R2T : THERMISTOR
M1F, M2F : FAN MOTOR
H1P, H2P, H3P: PILOT LAMP
YLW
: PROTECTIVE EARTH
X1M
2
3
1
FIELD WIRING.
3
2
1
outdoor
3D034713C